[AArch64] SVE tests
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / target.def
blob0a4f5fe6ef6d625ee34b35764357c6408da111e8
1 /* Target hook definitions.
2 Copyright (C) 2001-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
5 under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the
6 Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option) any
7 later version.
9 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
10 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
11 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
12 GNU General Public License for more details.
14 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
15 along with this program; see the file COPYING3. If not see
16 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
18 In other words, you are welcome to use, share and improve this program.
19 You are forbidden to forbid anyone else to use, share and improve
20 what you give them. Help stamp out software-hoarding! */
22 /* See target-hooks-macros.h for details of macros that should be
23 provided by the including file, and how to use them here. */
24 #include "target-hooks-macros.h"
26 #undef HOOK_TYPE
27 #define HOOK_TYPE "Target Hook"
29 HOOK_VECTOR (TARGET_INITIALIZER, gcc_target)
31 /* Functions that output assembler for the target. */
32 #define HOOK_PREFIX "TARGET_ASM_"
33 HOOK_VECTOR (TARGET_ASM_OUT, asm_out)
35 /* Opening and closing parentheses for asm expression grouping. */
36 DEFHOOKPOD
37 (open_paren,
38 "These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the\n\
39 assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they\n\
40 default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.",
41 const char *, "(")
42 DEFHOOKPODX (close_paren, const char *, ")")
44 /* Assembler instructions for creating various kinds of integer object. */
45 DEFHOOKPOD
46 (byte_op,
47 "@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP\n\
48 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP\n\
49 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP\n\
50 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP\n\
51 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP\n\
52 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP\n\
53 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP\n\
54 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP\n\
55 These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds\n\
56 of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a\n\
57 byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an\n\
58 aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be\n\
59 @code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.\n\
60 \n\
61 The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,\n\
62 followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,\n\
63 the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.",
64 const char *, "\t.byte\t")
65 DEFHOOKPOD (aligned_op, "*", struct asm_int_op, TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_INT_OP)
66 DEFHOOKPOD (unaligned_op, "*", struct asm_int_op, TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_INT_OP)
68 /* The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying
69 LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER. */
70 DEFHOOK
71 (label_align_after_barrier_max_skip,
72 "The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying\n\
73 @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if\n\
74 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.",
75 int, (rtx_insn *label),
76 default_label_align_after_barrier_max_skip)
78 /* The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying
79 LOOP_ALIGN. */
80 DEFHOOK
81 (loop_align_max_skip,
82 "The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to\n\
83 @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is\n\
84 defined.",
85 int, (rtx_insn *label),
86 default_loop_align_max_skip)
88 /* The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying
89 LABEL_ALIGN. */
90 DEFHOOK
91 (label_align_max_skip,
92 "The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}\n\
93 to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}\n\
94 is defined.",
95 int, (rtx_insn *label),
96 default_label_align_max_skip)
98 /* The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying
99 JUMP_ALIGN. */
100 DEFHOOK
101 (jump_align_max_skip,
102 "The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying\n\
103 @code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if\n\
104 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.",
105 int, (rtx_insn *label),
106 default_jump_align_max_skip)
108 /* Try to output the assembler code for an integer object whose
109 value is given by X. SIZE is the size of the object in bytes and
110 ALIGNED_P indicates whether it is aligned. Return true if
111 successful. Only handles cases for which BYTE_OP, ALIGNED_OP
112 and UNALIGNED_OP are NULL. */
113 DEFHOOK
114 (integer,
115 "The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an\n\
116 integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size\n\
117 in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The\n\
118 function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the\n\
119 object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to\n\
120 split the object into smaller parts.\n\
122 The default implementation of this hook will use the\n\
123 @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}\n\
124 when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.",
125 /* Only handles cases for which BYTE_OP, ALIGNED_OP and UNALIGNED_OP are
126 NULL. */
127 bool, (rtx x, unsigned int size, int aligned_p),
128 default_assemble_integer)
130 /* Notify the backend that we have completed emitting the data for a
131 decl. */
132 DEFHOOK
133 (decl_end,
134 "Define this hook if the target assembler requires a special marker to\n\
135 terminate an initialized variable declaration.",
136 void, (void),
137 hook_void_void)
139 /* Output code that will globalize a label. */
140 DEFHOOK
141 (globalize_label,
142 "This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream\n\
143 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;\n\
144 that is, available for reference from other files.\n\
146 The default implementation relies on a proper definition of\n\
147 @code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.",
148 void, (FILE *stream, const char *name),
149 default_globalize_label)
151 /* Output code that will globalize a declaration. */
152 DEFHOOK
153 (globalize_decl_name,
154 "This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream\n\
155 @var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}\n\
156 global; that is, available for reference from other files.\n\
158 The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.",
159 void, (FILE *stream, tree decl), default_globalize_decl_name)
161 /* Output code that will declare an external variable. */
162 DEFHOOK
163 (assemble_undefined_decl,
164 "This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream\n\
165 @var{stream} some commands that will declare the name associated with\n\
166 @var{decl} which is not defined in the current translation unit. Most\n\
167 assemblers do not require anything to be output in this case.",
168 void, (FILE *stream, const char *name, const_tree decl),
169 hook_void_FILEptr_constcharptr_const_tree)
171 /* Output code that will emit a label for unwind info, if this
172 target requires such labels. Second argument is the decl the
173 unwind info is associated with, third is a boolean: true if
174 this is for exception handling, fourth is a boolean: true if
175 this is only a placeholder for an omitted FDE. */
176 DEFHOOK
177 (emit_unwind_label,
178 "This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It\n\
179 should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it\n\
180 should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the\n\
181 function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.\n\
182 The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an\n\
183 exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:\n\
184 true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.\n\
186 The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.",
187 void, (FILE *stream, tree decl, int for_eh, int empty),
188 default_emit_unwind_label)
190 /* Output code that will emit a label to divide up the exception table. */
191 DEFHOOK
192 (emit_except_table_label,
193 "This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.\n\
194 It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table\n\
195 to be broken up according to function.\n\
197 The default is that no label is emitted.",
198 void, (FILE *stream),
199 default_emit_except_table_label)
201 /* Emit a directive for setting the personality for the function. */
202 DEFHOOK
203 (emit_except_personality,
204 "If the target implements @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT}, this hook may be\
205 used to emit a directive to install a personality hook into the unwind\
206 info. This hook should not be used if dwarf2 unwind info is used.",
207 void, (rtx personality),
208 NULL)
210 /* Emit any directives required to unwind this instruction. */
211 DEFHOOK
212 (unwind_emit,
213 "This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the\n\
214 given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}\n\
215 returns @code{UI_TARGET}.",
216 void, (FILE *stream, rtx_insn *insn),
217 NULL)
219 DEFHOOKPOD
220 (unwind_emit_before_insn,
221 "True if the @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT} hook should be called before\
222 the assembly for @var{insn} has been emitted, false if the hook should\
223 be called afterward.",
224 bool, true)
226 /* Generate an internal label.
227 For now this is just a wrapper for ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL. */
228 DEFHOOK_UNDOC
229 (generate_internal_label,
231 void, (char *buf, const char *prefix, unsigned long labelno),
232 default_generate_internal_label)
234 /* Output an internal label. */
235 DEFHOOK
236 (internal_label,
237 "A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose\n\
238 name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.\n\
240 It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels\n\
241 used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs\n\
242 will have name conflicts with internal labels.\n\
244 It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the\n\
245 object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that\n\
246 should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the\n\
247 beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what\n\
248 convention your system uses, and follow it.\n\
250 The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.",
251 void, (FILE *stream, const char *prefix, unsigned long labelno),
252 default_internal_label)
254 /* Output label for the constant. */
255 DEFHOOK
256 (declare_constant_name,
257 "A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary\n\
258 for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This\n\
259 target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using\n\
260 @code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,\n\
261 and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}\n\
262 will be an internal label.\n\
264 The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the\n\
265 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).\n\
267 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.",
268 void, (FILE *file, const char *name, const_tree expr, HOST_WIDE_INT size),
269 default_asm_declare_constant_name)
271 /* Emit a ttype table reference to a typeinfo object. */
272 DEFHOOK
273 (ttype,
274 "This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to\n\
275 the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}\n\
276 if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the\n\
277 reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.",
278 bool, (rtx sym),
279 hook_bool_rtx_false)
281 /* Emit an assembler directive to set visibility for the symbol
282 associated with the tree decl. */
283 DEFHOOK
284 (assemble_visibility,
285 "This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some\n\
286 commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have\n\
287 hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.",
288 void, (tree decl, int visibility),
289 default_assemble_visibility)
291 DEFHOOK
292 (print_patchable_function_entry,
293 "Generate a patchable area at the function start, consisting of\n\
294 @var{patch_area_size} NOP instructions. If the target supports named\n\
295 sections and if @var{record_p} is true, insert a pointer to the current\n\
296 location in the table of patchable functions. The default implementation\n\
297 of the hook places the table of pointers in the special section named\n\
298 @code{__patchable_function_entries}.",
299 void, (FILE *file, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT patch_area_size, bool record_p),
300 default_print_patchable_function_entry)
302 /* Output the assembler code for entry to a function. */
303 DEFHOOK
304 (function_prologue,
305 "If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a\n\
306 function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,\n\
307 initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be\n\
308 saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the\n\
309 local variables. @var{file} is a stdio stream to which the assembler\n\
310 code should be output.\n\
312 The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this\n\
313 macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.\n\
315 @findex regs_ever_live\n\
316 To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array\n\
317 @code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register\n\
318 @var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function\n\
319 prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the\n\
320 call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use\n\
321 @code{regs_ever_live}.)\n\
323 On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does\n\
324 not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if\n\
325 they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes\n\
326 appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used\n\
327 registers are used in the function.\n\
329 @findex frame_pointer_needed\n\
330 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the\n\
331 function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame\n\
332 pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a\n\
333 frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable\n\
334 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run\n\
335 time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.\n\
337 The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space\n\
338 required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions\n\
339 listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the\n\
340 order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the\n\
341 stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and\n\
342 the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order\n\
343 for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for\n\
344 compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard\n\
345 or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC\n\
346 need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.",
347 void, (FILE *file),
348 default_function_pro_epilogue)
350 /* Output the assembler code for end of prologue. */
351 DEFHOOK
352 (function_end_prologue,
353 "If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a\n\
354 prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being\n\
355 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be\n\
356 emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.",
357 void, (FILE *file),
358 no_asm_to_stream)
360 /* Output the assembler code for start of epilogue. */
361 DEFHOOK
362 (function_begin_epilogue,
363 "If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an\n\
364 epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being\n\
365 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be\n\
366 emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.",
367 void, (FILE *file),
368 no_asm_to_stream)
370 /* Output the assembler code for function exit. */
371 DEFHOOK
372 (function_epilogue,
373 "If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a\n\
374 function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved\n\
375 registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was\n\
376 called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the\n\
377 same argument as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the\n\
378 registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and\n\
379 @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.\n\
381 On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work\n\
382 of returning from the function. On these machines, give that\n\
383 instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro\n\
384 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.\n\
386 Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the\n\
387 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target\n\
388 switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,\n\
389 define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the\n\
390 target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity\n\
391 condition is false, epilogues will be used.\n\
393 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the\n\
394 function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these\n\
395 two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer\n\
396 is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable\n\
397 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling\n\
398 a function that needs a frame pointer.\n\
400 Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and\n\
401 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.\n\
402 The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a\n\
403 function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.\n\
405 On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while\n\
406 others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when\n\
407 given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed\n\
408 number of arguments.\n\
410 @findex pops_args\n\
411 @findex crtl->args.pops_args\n\
412 Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which\n\
413 functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}\n\
414 needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current\n\
415 function's arguments that this function should pop is available in\n\
416 @code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.",
417 void, (FILE *file),
418 default_function_pro_epilogue)
420 /* Initialize target-specific sections. */
421 DEFHOOK
422 (init_sections,
423 "Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the\n\
424 @file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections\n\
425 of its own that you need to create.\n\
427 GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing\n\
428 any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks\n\
429 described below.",
430 void, (void),
431 hook_void_void)
433 /* Tell assembler to change to section NAME with attributes FLAGS.
434 If DECL is non-NULL, it is the VAR_DECL or FUNCTION_DECL with
435 which this section is associated. */
436 DEFHOOK
437 (named_section,
438 "Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section\n\
439 should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask\n\
440 of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}\n\
441 is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which\n\
442 this section is associated.",
443 void, (const char *name, unsigned int flags, tree decl),
444 default_no_named_section)
446 /* Tell assembler what section attributes to assign this elf section
447 declaration, using their numerical value. */
448 DEFHOOK
449 (elf_flags_numeric,
450 "This hook can be used to encode ELF section flags for which no letter\n\
451 code has been defined in the assembler. It is called by\n\
452 @code{default_asm_named_section} whenever the section flags need to be\n\
453 emitted in the assembler output. If the hook returns true, then the\n\
454 numerical value for ELF section flags should be calculated from\n\
455 @var{flags} and saved in @var{*num}; the value is printed out instead of the\n\
456 normal sequence of letter codes. If the hook is not defined, or if it\n\
457 returns false, then @var{num} is ignored and the traditional letter sequence\n\
458 is emitted.",
459 bool, (unsigned int flags, unsigned int *num),
460 hook_bool_uint_uintp_false)
462 /* Return preferred text (sub)section for function DECL.
463 Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
464 functions. STARTUP is true when function is known to be used only
465 at startup (from static constructors or it is main()).
466 EXIT is true when function is known to be used only at exit
467 (from static destructors).
468 Return NULL if function should go to default text section. */
469 DEFHOOK
470 (function_section,
471 "Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.\n\
472 Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot\n\
473 functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only\n\
474 at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).\n\
475 @var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit\n\
476 (from static destructors).\n\
477 Return NULL if function should go to default text section.",
478 section *, (tree decl, enum node_frequency freq, bool startup, bool exit),
479 default_function_section)
481 /* Output the assembler code for function exit. */
482 DEFHOOK
483 (function_switched_text_sections,
484 "Used by the target to emit any assembler directives or additional\
485 labels needed when a function is partitioned between different\
486 sections. Output should be written to @var{file}. The function\
487 decl is available as @var{decl} and the new section is `cold' if\
488 @var{new_is_cold} is @code{true}.",
489 void, (FILE *file, tree decl, bool new_is_cold),
490 default_function_switched_text_sections)
492 /* Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
493 selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
494 should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
495 local relocations should be placed in a read-write section. */
496 DEFHOOK
497 (reloc_rw_mask,
498 "Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when\n\
499 selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations\n\
500 should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if\n\
501 local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.\n\
503 The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}\n\
504 is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined\n\
505 when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations\n\
506 in read-only sections even in executables.",
507 int, (void),
508 default_reloc_rw_mask)
510 /* Return a section for EXP. It may be a DECL or a constant. RELOC
511 is nonzero if runtime relocations must be applied; bit 1 will be
512 set if the runtime relocations require non-local name resolution.
513 ALIGN is the required alignment of the data. */
514 DEFHOOK
515 (select_section,
516 "Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can\n\
517 assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of\n\
518 some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}\n\
519 requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains\n\
520 local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.\n\
521 @var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.\n\
523 The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only\n\
524 variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.\n\
526 See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.",
527 section *, (tree exp, int reloc, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT align),
528 default_select_section)
530 /* Return a section for X. MODE is X's mode and ALIGN is its
531 alignment in bits. */
532 DEFHOOK
533 (select_rtx_section,
534 "Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},\n\
535 should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of\n\
536 constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the\n\
537 case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment\n\
538 in bits.\n\
540 The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic\n\
541 constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything\n\
542 else in @code{readonly_data_section}.",
543 section *, (machine_mode mode, rtx x, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT align),
544 default_select_rtx_section)
546 /* Select a unique section name for DECL. RELOC is the same as
547 for SELECT_SECTION. */
548 DEFHOOK
549 (unique_section,
550 "Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,\n\
551 and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.\n\
552 As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether\n\
553 the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.\n\
555 The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the\n\
556 ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For\n\
557 example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.\n\
558 Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.",
559 void, (tree decl, int reloc),
560 default_unique_section)
562 /* Return the readonly data section associated with function DECL. */
563 DEFHOOK
564 (function_rodata_section,
565 "Return the readonly data section associated with\n\
566 @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.\n\
567 The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if\n\
568 the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}\n\
569 if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section\n\
570 otherwise.",
571 section *, (tree decl),
572 default_function_rodata_section)
574 /* Nonnull if the target wants to override the default ".rodata" prefix
575 for mergeable data sections. */
576 DEFHOOKPOD
577 (mergeable_rodata_prefix,
578 "Usually, the compiler uses the prefix @code{\".rodata\"} to construct\n\
579 section names for mergeable constant data. Define this macro to override\n\
580 the string if a different section name should be used.",
581 const char *, ".rodata")
583 /* Return the section to be used for transactional memory clone tables. */
584 DEFHOOK
585 (tm_clone_table_section,
586 "Return the section that should be used for transactional memory clone\
587 tables.",
588 section *, (void), default_clone_table_section)
590 /* Output a constructor for a symbol with a given priority. */
591 DEFHOOK
592 (constructor,
593 "If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call\n\
594 the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.\n\
596 Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking\n\
597 no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization\n\
598 priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};\n\
599 otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.\n\
601 If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will\n\
602 be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the\n\
603 target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}\n\
604 is not defined.",
605 void, (rtx symbol, int priority), NULL)
607 /* Output a destructor for a symbol with a given priority. */
608 DEFHOOK
609 (destructor,
610 "This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination\n\
611 functions rather than initialization functions.",
612 void, (rtx symbol, int priority), NULL)
614 /* Output the assembler code for a thunk function. THUNK_DECL is the
615 declaration for the thunk function itself, FUNCTION is the decl for
616 the target function. DELTA is an immediate constant offset to be
617 added to THIS. If VCALL_OFFSET is nonzero, the word at
618 *(*this + vcall_offset) should be added to THIS. */
619 DEFHOOK
620 (output_mi_thunk,
621 "A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk\n\
622 function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple\n\
623 inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,\n\
624 adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to\n\
625 the real function.\n\
627 First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that\n\
628 contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument\n\
629 contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer\n\
630 in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,\n\
631 e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of\n\
632 all other incoming arguments.\n\
634 Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be\n\
635 made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the\n\
636 adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:\n\
638 @smallexample\n\
639 p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]\n\
640 @end smallexample\n\
642 After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a\n\
643 @code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does\n\
644 not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will\n\
645 return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.\n\
647 The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with\n\
648 the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all\n\
649 of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}\n\
650 and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.\n\
652 The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}\n\
653 have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on\n\
654 some targets, but probably not.\n\
656 If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++\n\
657 front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls\n\
658 @var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does\n\
659 not support varargs.",
660 void, (FILE *file, tree thunk_fndecl, HOST_WIDE_INT delta,
661 HOST_WIDE_INT vcall_offset, tree function),
662 NULL)
664 /* Determine whether output_mi_thunk would succeed. */
665 /* ??? Ideally, this hook would not exist, and success or failure
666 would be returned from output_mi_thunk directly. But there's
667 too much undo-able setup involved in invoking output_mi_thunk.
668 Could be fixed by making output_mi_thunk emit rtl instead of
669 text to the output file. */
670 DEFHOOK
671 (can_output_mi_thunk,
672 "A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able\n\
673 to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the\n\
674 arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the\n\
675 generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations\n\
676 previously exposed.",
677 bool, (const_tree thunk_fndecl, HOST_WIDE_INT delta,
678 HOST_WIDE_INT vcall_offset, const_tree function),
679 hook_bool_const_tree_hwi_hwi_const_tree_false)
681 /* Output any boilerplate text needed at the beginning of a
682 translation unit. */
683 DEFHOOK
684 (file_start,
685 "Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to\n\
686 find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled\n\
687 by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is\n\
688 quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call\n\
689 @code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This\n\
690 lets other target files rely on these variables.",
691 void, (void),
692 default_file_start)
694 /* Output any boilerplate text needed at the end of a translation unit. */
695 DEFHOOK
696 (file_end,
697 "Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects\n\
698 to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.",
699 void, (void),
700 hook_void_void)
702 /* Output any boilerplate text needed at the beginning of an
703 LTO output stream. */
704 DEFHOOK
705 (lto_start,
706 "Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects\n\
707 to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output\n\
708 nothing.",
709 void, (void),
710 hook_void_void)
712 /* Output any boilerplate text needed at the end of an
713 LTO output stream. */
714 DEFHOOK
715 (lto_end,
716 "Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects\n\
717 to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output\n\
718 nothing.",
719 void, (void),
720 hook_void_void)
722 /* Output any boilerplace text needed at the end of a
723 translation unit before debug and unwind info is emitted. */
724 DEFHOOK
725 (code_end,
726 "Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting\n\
727 unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit\n\
728 here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,\n\
729 because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output\n\
730 nothing.",
731 void, (void),
732 hook_void_void)
734 /* Output an assembler pseudo-op to declare a library function name
735 external. */
736 DEFHOOK
737 (external_libcall,
738 "This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler\n\
739 pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the\n\
740 library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.",
741 void, (rtx symref),
742 default_external_libcall)
744 /* Output an assembler directive to mark decl live. This instructs
745 linker to not dead code strip this symbol. */
746 DEFHOOK
747 (mark_decl_preserved,
748 "This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler\n\
749 directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the\n\
750 .no_dead_code_strip directive.",
751 void, (const char *symbol),
752 hook_void_constcharptr)
754 /* Output a record of the command line switches that have been passed. */
755 DEFHOOK
756 (record_gcc_switches,
757 "Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line\n\
758 switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are\n\
759 enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.\n\
760 It can take the following values:\n\
762 @table @gcctabopt\n\
763 @item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED\n\
764 @var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.\n\
766 @item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED\n\
767 @var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a\n\
768 direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by\n\
769 default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different\n\
770 command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables\n\
771 various different individual optimization passes.\n\
773 @item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE\n\
774 @var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be\n\
775 ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the\n\
776 target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first\n\
777 time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the\n\
778 warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for\n\
779 wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any\n\
780 necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to\n\
781 perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording\n\
782 switches.\n\
784 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START\n\
785 This option can be ignored by this target hook.\n\
787 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END\n\
788 This option can be ignored by this target hook.\n\
789 @end table\n\
791 The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be\n\
792 supported in the future.\n\
794 By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is\n\
795 provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},\n\
796 it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable\n\
797 section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is\n\
798 provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target\n\
799 hook.",
800 int, (print_switch_type type, const char *text),
801 NULL)
803 /* The name of the section that the example ELF implementation of
804 record_gcc_switches will use to store the information. Target
805 specific versions of record_gcc_switches may or may not use
806 this information. */
807 DEFHOOKPOD
808 (record_gcc_switches_section,
809 "This is the name of the section that will be created by the example\n\
810 ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target\n\
811 hook.",
812 const char *, ".GCC.command.line")
814 /* Output the definition of a section anchor. */
815 DEFHOOK
816 (output_anchor,
817 "Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a\n\
818 @code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.\n\
819 The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning\n\
820 of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.\n\
822 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses\n\
823 it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.\n\
824 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition\n\
825 is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.",
826 void, (rtx x),
827 default_asm_output_anchor)
829 DEFHOOK
830 (output_ident,
831 "Output a string based on @var{name}, suitable for the @samp{#ident} \
832 directive, or the equivalent directive or pragma in non-C-family languages. \
833 If this hook is not defined, nothing is output for the @samp{#ident} \
834 directive.",
835 void, (const char *name),
836 hook_void_constcharptr)
838 /* Output a DTP-relative reference to a TLS symbol. */
839 DEFHOOK
840 (output_dwarf_dtprel,
841 "If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative\n\
842 reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.",
843 void, (FILE *file, int size, rtx x),
844 NULL)
846 /* Some target machines need to postscan each insn after it is output. */
847 DEFHOOK
848 (final_postscan_insn,
849 "If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the\n\
850 output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler\n\
851 if necessary.\n\
853 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands\n\
854 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of\n\
855 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.\n\
856 The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn\n\
857 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode\n\
858 by checking the contents of the vector.",
859 void, (FILE *file, rtx_insn *insn, rtx *opvec, int noperands),
860 NULL)
862 /* Emit the trampoline template. This hook may be NULL. */
863 DEFHOOK
864 (trampoline_template,
865 "This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,\n\
866 on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains\n\
867 the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a\n\
868 label---the label is taken care of automatically.\n\
870 If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed\n\
871 for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move\n\
872 code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code\n\
873 to generate it on the spot.",
874 void, (FILE *f),
875 NULL)
877 DEFHOOK
878 (output_source_filename,
879 "Output DWARF debugging information which indicates that filename\
880 @var{name} is the current source file to the stdio stream @var{file}.\n\
882 This target hook need not be defined if the standard form of output\
883 for the file format in use is appropriate.",
884 void ,(FILE *file, const char *name),
885 default_asm_output_source_filename)
887 DEFHOOK
888 (output_addr_const_extra,
889 "A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}\n\
890 can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to\n\
891 the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent\n\
892 @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.\n\
894 If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},\n\
895 so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message\n\
896 itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just\n\
897 return @code{true}.",
898 bool, (FILE *file, rtx x),
899 hook_bool_FILEptr_rtx_false)
901 /* ??? The TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND* hooks are part of the asm_out struct,
902 even though that is not reflected in the macro name to override their
903 initializers. */
904 #undef HOOK_PREFIX
905 #define HOOK_PREFIX "TARGET_"
907 /* Emit a machine-specific insn operand. */
908 /* ??? tm.texi only documents the old macro PRINT_OPERAND,
909 not this hook, and uses a different name for the argument FILE. */
910 DEFHOOK_UNDOC
911 (print_operand,
913 void, (FILE *file, rtx x, int code),
914 default_print_operand)
916 /* Emit a machine-specific memory address. */
917 /* ??? tm.texi only documents the old macro PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS,
918 not this hook, and uses different argument names. */
919 DEFHOOK_UNDOC
920 (print_operand_address,
922 void, (FILE *file, machine_mode mode, rtx addr),
923 default_print_operand_address)
925 /* Determine whether CODE is a valid punctuation character for the
926 `print_operand' hook. */
927 /* ??? tm.texi only documents the old macro PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P,
928 not this hook. */
929 DEFHOOK_UNDOC
930 (print_operand_punct_valid_p,
932 bool ,(unsigned char code),
933 default_print_operand_punct_valid_p)
935 /* Given a symbol name, perform same mangling as assemble_name and
936 ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF, returning result as an IDENTIFIER_NODE. */
937 DEFHOOK
938 (mangle_assembler_name,
939 "Given a symbol @var{name}, perform same mangling as @code{varasm.c}'s\
940 @code{assemble_name}, but in memory rather than to a file stream, returning\
941 result as an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE}. Required for correct LTO symtabs. The\
942 default implementation calls the @code{TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING} hook and\
943 then prepends the @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX}, if any.",
944 tree, (const char *name),
945 default_mangle_assembler_name)
947 HOOK_VECTOR_END (asm_out)
949 /* Functions relating to instruction scheduling. All of these
950 default to null pointers, which haifa-sched.c looks for and handles. */
951 #undef HOOK_PREFIX
952 #define HOOK_PREFIX "TARGET_SCHED_"
953 HOOK_VECTOR (TARGET_SCHED, sched)
955 /* Given the current cost, COST, of an insn, INSN, calculate and
956 return a new cost based on its relationship to DEP_INSN through
957 the dependence LINK. The default is to make no adjustment. */
958 DEFHOOK
959 (adjust_cost,
960 "This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the\n\
961 relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through a\n\
962 dependence of type dep_type, and strength @var{dw}. It should return the new\n\
963 value. The default is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be\n\
964 used for example to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline\n\
965 description that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost\n\
966 as a data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline\n\
967 description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of\n\
968 output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency\n\
969 times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not\n\
970 acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also\n\
971 @pxref{Processor pipeline description}.",
972 int, (rtx_insn *insn, int dep_type1, rtx_insn *dep_insn, int cost,
973 unsigned int dw),
974 NULL)
976 /* Adjust the priority of an insn as you see fit. Returns the new priority. */
977 DEFHOOK
978 (adjust_priority,
979 "This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of\n\
980 @var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to\n\
981 execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}\n\
982 later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the\n\
983 scheduling priorities of insns.",
984 int, (rtx_insn *insn, int priority), NULL)
986 /* Function which returns the maximum number of insns that can be
987 scheduled in the same machine cycle. This must be constant
988 over an entire compilation. The default is 1. */
989 DEFHOOK
990 (issue_rate,
991 "This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever\n\
992 issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.\n\
993 Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue\n\
994 an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional\n\
995 constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see\n\
996 hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).\n\
997 This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need\n\
998 it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use\n\
999 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.",
1000 int, (void), NULL)
1002 /* Calculate how much this insn affects how many more insns we
1003 can emit this cycle. Default is they all cost the same. */
1004 DEFHOOK
1005 (variable_issue,
1006 "This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn\n\
1007 from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can\n\
1008 still be issued in the current cycle. The default is\n\
1009 @samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and\n\
1010 @code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.\n\
1011 You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources\n\
1012 than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.\n\
1013 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any\n\
1014 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by\n\
1015 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that\n\
1016 was scheduled.",
1017 int, (FILE *file, int verbose, rtx_insn *insn, int more), NULL)
1019 /* Initialize machine-dependent scheduling code. */
1020 DEFHOOK
1021 (init,
1022 "This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of\n\
1023 instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null\n\
1024 pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}\n\
1025 is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.\n\
1026 @var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling\n\
1027 region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate\n\
1028 scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.",
1029 void, (FILE *file, int verbose, int max_ready), NULL)
1031 /* Finalize machine-dependent scheduling code. */
1032 DEFHOOK
1033 (finish,
1034 "This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of\n\
1035 instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform\n\
1036 cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}\n\
1037 is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output\n\
1038 to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by\n\
1039 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.",
1040 void, (FILE *file, int verbose), NULL)
1042 /* Initialize machine-dependent function wide scheduling code. */
1043 DEFHOOK
1044 (init_global,
1045 "This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.\n\
1046 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.\n\
1047 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.\n\
1048 @var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.",
1049 void, (FILE *file, int verbose, int old_max_uid), NULL)
1051 /* Finalize machine-dependent function wide scheduling code. */
1052 DEFHOOK
1053 (finish_global,
1054 "This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.\n\
1055 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.\n\
1056 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.",
1057 void, (FILE *file, int verbose), NULL)
1059 /* Reorder insns in a machine-dependent fashion, in two different
1060 places. Default does nothing. */
1061 DEFHOOK
1062 (reorder,
1063 "This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready\n\
1064 list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to\n\
1065 combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).\n\
1066 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any\n\
1067 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by\n\
1068 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready\n\
1069 list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is\n\
1070 a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler\n\
1071 reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with\n\
1072 @var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}\n\
1073 is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and\n\
1074 the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that\n\
1075 can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also\n\
1076 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.",
1077 int, (FILE *file, int verbose, rtx_insn **ready, int *n_readyp, int clock), NULL)
1079 DEFHOOK
1080 (reorder2,
1081 "Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That\n\
1082 function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one\n\
1083 is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after\n\
1084 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and\n\
1085 return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining\n\
1086 this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where\n\
1087 scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same\n\
1088 cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.",
1089 int, (FILE *file, int verbose, rtx_insn **ready, int *n_readyp, int clock), NULL)
1091 DEFHOOK
1092 (macro_fusion_p,
1093 "This hook is used to check whether target platform supports macro fusion.",
1094 bool, (void), NULL)
1096 DEFHOOK
1097 (macro_fusion_pair_p,
1098 "This hook is used to check whether two insns should be macro fused for\n\
1099 a target microarchitecture. If this hook returns true for the given insn pair\n\
1100 (@var{prev} and @var{curr}), the scheduler will put them into a sched\n\
1101 group, and they will not be scheduled apart. The two insns will be either\n\
1102 two SET insns or a compare and a conditional jump and this hook should\n\
1103 validate any dependencies needed to fuse the two insns together.",
1104 bool, (rtx_insn *prev, rtx_insn *curr), NULL)
1106 /* The following member value is a pointer to a function called
1107 after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in chain given
1108 by two parameter values (head and tail correspondingly). */
1109 DEFHOOK
1110 (dependencies_evaluation_hook,
1111 "This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in\n\
1112 chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}\n\
1113 correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For\n\
1114 example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires\n\
1115 analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward\n\
1116 dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already\n\
1117 calculated.",
1118 void, (rtx_insn *head, rtx_insn *tail), NULL)
1120 /* The values of the following four members are pointers to functions
1121 used to simplify the automaton descriptions. dfa_pre_cycle_insn and
1122 dfa_post_cycle_insn give functions returning insns which are used to
1123 change the pipeline hazard recognizer state when the new simulated
1124 processor cycle correspondingly starts and finishes. The function
1125 defined by init_dfa_pre_cycle_insn and init_dfa_post_cycle_insn are
1126 used to initialize the corresponding insns. The default values of
1127 the members result in not changing the automaton state when the
1128 new simulated processor cycle correspondingly starts and finishes. */
1130 DEFHOOK
1131 (init_dfa_pre_cycle_insn,
1132 "The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.",
1133 void, (void), NULL)
1135 DEFHOOK
1136 (dfa_pre_cycle_insn,
1137 "The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the\n\
1138 pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled\n\
1139 when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may\n\
1140 simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}\n\
1141 processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton\n\
1142 based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state\n\
1143 when the new simulated processor cycle starts.",
1144 rtx, (void), NULL)
1146 DEFHOOK
1147 (init_dfa_post_cycle_insn,
1148 "The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but\n\
1149 used to initialize data used by the previous hook.",
1150 void, (void), NULL)
1152 DEFHOOK
1153 (dfa_post_cycle_insn,
1154 "The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used\n\
1155 to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new\n\
1156 simulated processor cycle finishes.",
1157 rtx_insn *, (void), NULL)
1159 /* The values of the following two members are pointers to
1160 functions used to simplify the automaton descriptions.
1161 dfa_pre_advance_cycle and dfa_post_advance_cycle are getting called
1162 immediately before and after cycle is advanced. */
1164 DEFHOOK
1165 (dfa_pre_advance_cycle,
1166 "The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.\n\
1167 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used\n\
1168 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing\n\
1169 state on a single insn is not enough.",
1170 void, (void), NULL)
1172 DEFHOOK
1173 (dfa_post_advance_cycle,
1174 "The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.\n\
1175 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used\n\
1176 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing\n\
1177 state on a single insn is not enough.",
1178 void, (void), NULL)
1180 /* The following member value is a pointer to a function returning value
1181 which defines how many insns in queue `ready' will we try for
1182 multi-pass scheduling. If the member value is nonzero and the
1183 function returns positive value, the DFA based scheduler will make
1184 multi-pass scheduling for the first cycle. In other words, we will
1185 try to choose ready insn which permits to start maximum number of
1186 insns on the same cycle. */
1187 DEFHOOK
1188 (first_cycle_multipass_dfa_lookahead,
1189 "This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue\n\
1190 for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler\n\
1191 chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive\n\
1192 value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of\n\
1193 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}\n\
1194 subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in\n\
1195 maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the\n\
1196 @acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of\n\
1197 packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the\n\
1198 rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.\n\
1200 This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}\n\
1201 processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor\n\
1202 with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or\n\
1203 @var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or\n\
1204 @var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The\n\
1205 processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into\n\
1206 @var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}\n\
1207 until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,\n\
1208 the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.\n\
1210 Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based\n\
1211 pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn\n\
1212 schedules to choose the best one.\n\
1214 The default is no multipass scheduling.",
1215 int, (void), NULL)
1217 /* The following member value is pointer to a function controlling
1218 what insns from the ready insn queue will be considered for the
1219 multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns zero for insn
1220 passed as the parameter, the insn will be not chosen to be issued. */
1221 DEFHOOK
1222 (first_cycle_multipass_dfa_lookahead_guard,
1223 "\n\
1224 This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be\n\
1225 considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns\n\
1226 zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be considered in multipass scheduling.\n\
1227 Positive return values will remove @var{insn} from consideration on\n\
1228 the current round of multipass scheduling.\n\
1229 Negative return values will remove @var{insn} from consideration for given\n\
1230 number of cycles.\n\
1231 Backends should be careful about returning non-zero for highest priority\n\
1232 instruction at position 0 in the ready list. @var{ready_index} is passed\n\
1233 to allow backends make correct judgements.\n\
1235 The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.",
1236 int, (rtx_insn *insn, int ready_index), NULL)
1238 /* This hook prepares the target for a new round of multipass
1239 scheduling.
1240 DATA is a pointer to target-specific data used for multipass scheduling.
1241 READY_TRY and N_READY represent the current state of search in the
1242 optimization space. The target can filter out instructions that
1243 should not be tried during current round by setting corresponding
1244 elements in READY_TRY to non-zero.
1245 FIRST_CYCLE_INSN_P is true if this is the first round of multipass
1246 scheduling on current cycle. */
1247 DEFHOOK
1248 (first_cycle_multipass_begin,
1249 "This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass\n\
1250 scheduling.",
1251 void, (void *data, signed char *ready_try, int n_ready, bool first_cycle_insn_p),
1252 NULL)
1254 /* This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
1255 DATA is a pointer to target-specific data that can be used to record effects
1256 of INSN on CPU that are not described in DFA.
1257 READY_TRY and N_READY represent the current state of search in the
1258 optimization space. The target can filter out instructions that
1259 should not be tried after issuing INSN by setting corresponding
1260 elements in READY_TRY to non-zero.
1261 INSN is the instruction being evaluated.
1262 PREV_DATA is a pointer to target-specific data corresponding
1263 to a state before issuing INSN. */
1264 DEFHOOK
1265 (first_cycle_multipass_issue,
1266 "This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.",
1267 void, (void *data, signed char *ready_try, int n_ready, rtx_insn *insn,
1268 const void *prev_data), NULL)
1270 /* This hook is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
1271 instruction corresponding to DATA.
1272 DATA is a pointer to target-specific data that stores the effects
1273 of instruction from which the algorithm backtracks on CPU that are not
1274 described in DFA.
1275 READY_TRY and N_READY represent the current state of search in the
1276 optimization space. The target can filter out instructions that
1277 should not be tried after issuing INSN by setting corresponding
1278 elements in READY_TRY to non-zero. */
1279 DEFHOOK
1280 (first_cycle_multipass_backtrack,
1281 "This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of\n\
1282 an instruction.",
1283 void, (const void *data, signed char *ready_try, int n_ready), NULL)
1285 /* This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
1286 round of multipass scheduling.
1287 DATA is a pointer.
1288 If DATA is non-NULL it points to target-specific data used for multipass
1289 scheduling which corresponds to instruction at the start of the chain of
1290 the winning solution. DATA is NULL when multipass scheduling cannot find
1291 a good enough solution on current cycle and decides to retry later,
1292 usually after advancing the cycle count. */
1293 DEFHOOK
1294 (first_cycle_multipass_end,
1295 "This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current\n\
1296 round of multipass scheduling.",
1297 void, (const void *data), NULL)
1299 /* This hook is called to initialize target-specific data for multipass
1300 scheduling after it has been allocated.
1301 DATA is a pointer to target-specific data that stores the effects
1302 of instruction from which the algorithm backtracks on CPU that are not
1303 described in DFA. */
1304 DEFHOOK
1305 (first_cycle_multipass_init,
1306 "This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.",
1307 void, (void *data), NULL)
1309 /* This hook is called to finalize target-specific data for multipass
1310 scheduling before it is deallocated.
1311 DATA is a pointer to target-specific data that stores the effects
1312 of instruction from which the algorithm backtracks on CPU that are not
1313 described in DFA. */
1314 DEFHOOK
1315 (first_cycle_multipass_fini,
1316 "This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.",
1317 void, (void *data), NULL)
1319 /* The following member value is pointer to a function called by
1320 the insn scheduler before issuing insn passed as the third
1321 parameter on given cycle. If the hook returns nonzero, the
1322 insn is not issued on given processors cycle. Instead of that,
1323 the processor cycle is advanced. If the value passed through
1324 the last parameter is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted
1325 on the new cycle start as usually. The first parameter passes
1326 file for debugging output. The second one passes the scheduler
1327 verbose level of the debugging output. The forth and the fifth
1328 parameter values are correspondingly processor cycle on which
1329 the previous insn has been issued and the current processor cycle. */
1330 DEFHOOK
1331 (dfa_new_cycle,
1332 "This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}\n\
1333 on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,\n\
1334 @var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,\n\
1335 the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}\n\
1336 is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle\n\
1337 start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and\n\
1338 verbosity level to use for debugging output.\n\
1339 @var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the\n\
1340 processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,\n\
1341 and the current processor cycle.",
1342 int, (FILE *dump, int verbose, rtx_insn *insn, int last_clock,
1343 int clock, int *sort_p),
1344 NULL)
1346 /* The following member value is a pointer to a function called by the
1347 insn scheduler. It should return true if there exists a dependence
1348 which is considered costly by the target, between the insn
1349 DEP_PRO (&_DEP), and the insn DEP_CON (&_DEP). The first parameter is
1350 the dep that represents the dependence between the two insns. The
1351 second argument is the cost of the dependence as estimated by
1352 the scheduler. The last argument is the distance in cycles
1353 between the already scheduled insn (first parameter) and the
1354 second insn (second parameter). */
1355 DEFHOOK
1356 (is_costly_dependence,
1357 "This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by\n\
1358 the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that\n\
1359 are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters\n\
1360 to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence\n\
1361 being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the\n\
1362 dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third\n\
1363 parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.\n\
1364 The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two\n\
1365 insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,\n\
1366 and @code{false} otherwise.\n\
1368 Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,\n\
1369 where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource\n\
1370 delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping\n\
1371 that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very\n\
1372 important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns\n\
1373 closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,\n\
1374 not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.",
1375 bool, (struct _dep *_dep, int cost, int distance), NULL)
1377 /* The following member value is a pointer to a function called
1378 by the insn scheduler. This hook is called to notify the backend
1379 that new instructions were emitted. */
1380 DEFHOOK
1381 (h_i_d_extended,
1382 "This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to\n\
1383 the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its\n\
1384 per instruction data structures.",
1385 void, (void), NULL)
1387 /* Next 5 functions are for multi-point scheduling. */
1389 /* Allocate memory for scheduler context. */
1390 DEFHOOK
1391 (alloc_sched_context,
1392 "Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.",
1393 void *, (void), NULL)
1395 /* Fills the context from the local machine scheduler context. */
1396 DEFHOOK
1397 (init_sched_context,
1398 "Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.\n\
1399 It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the\n\
1400 beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.",
1401 void, (void *tc, bool clean_p), NULL)
1403 /* Sets local machine scheduler context to a saved value. */
1404 DEFHOOK
1405 (set_sched_context,
1406 "Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.",
1407 void, (void *tc), NULL)
1409 /* Clears a scheduler context so it becomes like after init. */
1410 DEFHOOK
1411 (clear_sched_context,
1412 "Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.",
1413 void, (void *tc), NULL)
1415 /* Frees the scheduler context. */
1416 DEFHOOK
1417 (free_sched_context,
1418 "Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.",
1419 void, (void *tc), NULL)
1421 /* The following member value is a pointer to a function called
1422 by the insn scheduler.
1423 The first parameter is an instruction, the second parameter is the type
1424 of the requested speculation, and the third parameter is a pointer to the
1425 speculative pattern of the corresponding type (set if return value == 1).
1426 It should return
1427 -1, if there is no pattern, that will satisfy the requested speculation type,
1428 0, if current pattern satisfies the requested speculation type,
1429 1, if pattern of the instruction should be changed to the newly
1430 generated one. */
1431 DEFHOOK
1432 (speculate_insn,
1433 "This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only\n\
1434 speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.\n\
1435 The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative\n\
1436 version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative\n\
1437 pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,\n\
1438 or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested\n\
1439 speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned\n\
1440 the generated speculative pattern.",
1441 int, (rtx_insn *insn, unsigned int dep_status, rtx *new_pat), NULL)
1443 /* The following member value is a pointer to a function called
1444 by the insn scheduler. It should return true if the check instruction
1445 passed as the parameter needs a recovery block. */
1446 DEFHOOK
1447 (needs_block_p,
1448 "This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code\n\
1449 for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check\n\
1450 instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.",
1451 bool, (unsigned int dep_status), NULL)
1453 /* The following member value is a pointer to a function called
1454 by the insn scheduler. It should return a pattern for the check
1455 instruction.
1456 The first parameter is a speculative instruction, the second parameter
1457 is the label of the corresponding recovery block (or null, if it is a
1458 simple check). The third parameter is the kind of speculation that
1459 is being performed. */
1460 DEFHOOK
1461 (gen_spec_check,
1462 "This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery\n\
1463 check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a\n\
1464 speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.\n\
1465 @var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should\n\
1466 be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to\n\
1467 recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then\n\
1468 a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by\n\
1469 @var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.",
1470 rtx, (rtx_insn *insn, rtx_insn *label, unsigned int ds), NULL)
1472 /* The following member value is a pointer to a function that provides
1473 information about the speculation capabilities of the target.
1474 The parameter is a pointer to spec_info variable. */
1475 DEFHOOK
1476 (set_sched_flags,
1477 "This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be\n\
1478 enabled/used.\n\
1479 The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.\n\
1480 The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.",
1481 void, (struct spec_info_def *spec_info), NULL)
1483 DEFHOOK_UNDOC
1484 (get_insn_spec_ds,
1485 "Return speculation types of instruction @var{insn}.",
1486 unsigned int, (rtx_insn *insn), NULL)
1488 DEFHOOK_UNDOC
1489 (get_insn_checked_ds,
1490 "Return speculation types that are checked for instruction @var{insn}",
1491 unsigned int, (rtx_insn *insn), NULL)
1493 DEFHOOK
1494 (can_speculate_insn,
1495 "Some instructions should never be speculated by the schedulers, usually\n\
1496 because the instruction is too expensive to get this wrong. Often such\n\
1497 instructions have long latency, and often they are not fully modeled in the\n\
1498 pipeline descriptions. This hook should return @code{false} if @var{insn}\n\
1499 should not be speculated.",
1500 bool, (rtx_insn *insn), hook_bool_rtx_insn_true)
1502 DEFHOOK_UNDOC
1503 (skip_rtx_p,
1504 "Return bool if rtx scanning should just skip current layer and\
1505 advance to the inner rtxes.",
1506 bool, (const_rtx x), NULL)
1508 /* The following member value is a pointer to a function that provides
1509 information about the target resource-based lower bound which is
1510 used by the swing modulo scheduler. The parameter is a pointer
1511 to ddg variable. */
1512 DEFHOOK
1513 (sms_res_mii,
1514 "This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a\n\
1515 resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in\n\
1516 the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target\n\
1517 backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower\n\
1518 bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number\n\
1519 of instructions divided by the issue rate.",
1520 int, (struct ddg *g), NULL)
1522 /* The following member value is a function that initializes dispatch
1523 schedling and adds instructions to dispatch window according to its
1524 parameters. */
1525 DEFHOOK
1526 (dispatch_do,
1527 "This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified\n\
1528 in its second parameter.",
1529 void, (rtx_insn *insn, int x),
1530 hook_void_rtx_insn_int)
1532 /* The following member value is a a function that returns true is
1533 dispatch schedling is supported in hardware and condition passed
1534 as the second parameter is true. */
1535 DEFHOOK
1536 (dispatch,
1537 "This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling\n\
1538 is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.",
1539 bool, (rtx_insn *insn, int x),
1540 hook_bool_rtx_insn_int_false)
1542 DEFHOOKPOD
1543 (exposed_pipeline,
1544 "True if the processor has an exposed pipeline, which means that not just\n\
1545 the order of instructions is important for correctness when scheduling, but\n\
1546 also the latencies of operations.",
1547 bool, false)
1549 /* The following member value is a function that returns number
1550 of operations reassociator should try to put in parallel for
1551 statements of the given type. By default 1 is used. */
1552 DEFHOOK
1553 (reassociation_width,
1554 "This hook is called by tree reassociator to determine a level of\n\
1555 parallelism required in output calculations chain.",
1556 int, (unsigned int opc, machine_mode mode),
1557 hook_int_uint_mode_1)
1559 /* The following member value is a function that returns priority for
1560 fusion of each instruction via pointer parameters. */
1561 DEFHOOK
1562 (fusion_priority,
1563 "This hook is called by scheduling fusion pass. It calculates fusion\n\
1564 priorities for each instruction passed in by parameter. The priorities\n\
1565 are returned via pointer parameters.\n\
1567 @var{insn} is the instruction whose priorities need to be calculated.\n\
1568 @var{max_pri} is the maximum priority can be returned in any cases.\n\
1569 @var{fusion_pri} is the pointer parameter through which @var{insn}'s\n\
1570 fusion priority should be calculated and returned.\n\
1571 @var{pri} is the pointer parameter through which @var{insn}'s priority\n\
1572 should be calculated and returned.\n\
1574 Same @var{fusion_pri} should be returned for instructions which should\n\
1575 be scheduled together. Different @var{pri} should be returned for\n\
1576 instructions with same @var{fusion_pri}. @var{fusion_pri} is the major\n\
1577 sort key, @var{pri} is the minor sort key. All instructions will be\n\
1578 scheduled according to the two priorities. All priorities calculated\n\
1579 should be between 0 (exclusive) and @var{max_pri} (inclusive). To avoid\n\
1580 false dependencies, @var{fusion_pri} of instructions which need to be\n\
1581 scheduled together should be smaller than @var{fusion_pri} of irrelevant\n\
1582 instructions.\n\
1584 Given below example:\n\
1586 @smallexample\n\
1587 ldr r10, [r1, 4]\n\
1588 add r4, r4, r10\n\
1589 ldr r15, [r2, 8]\n\
1590 sub r5, r5, r15\n\
1591 ldr r11, [r1, 0]\n\
1592 add r4, r4, r11\n\
1593 ldr r16, [r2, 12]\n\
1594 sub r5, r5, r16\n\
1595 @end smallexample\n\
1597 On targets like ARM/AArch64, the two pairs of consecutive loads should be\n\
1598 merged. Since peephole2 pass can't help in this case unless consecutive\n\
1599 loads are actually next to each other in instruction flow. That's where\n\
1600 this scheduling fusion pass works. This hook calculates priority for each\n\
1601 instruction based on its fustion type, like:\n\
1603 @smallexample\n\
1604 ldr r10, [r1, 4] ; fusion_pri=99, pri=96\n\
1605 add r4, r4, r10 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100\n\
1606 ldr r15, [r2, 8] ; fusion_pri=98, pri=92\n\
1607 sub r5, r5, r15 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100\n\
1608 ldr r11, [r1, 0] ; fusion_pri=99, pri=100\n\
1609 add r4, r4, r11 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100\n\
1610 ldr r16, [r2, 12] ; fusion_pri=98, pri=88\n\
1611 sub r5, r5, r16 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100\n\
1612 @end smallexample\n\
1614 Scheduling fusion pass then sorts all ready to issue instructions according\n\
1615 to the priorities. As a result, instructions of same fusion type will be\n\
1616 pushed together in instruction flow, like:\n\
1618 @smallexample\n\
1619 ldr r11, [r1, 0]\n\
1620 ldr r10, [r1, 4]\n\
1621 ldr r15, [r2, 8]\n\
1622 ldr r16, [r2, 12]\n\
1623 add r4, r4, r10\n\
1624 sub r5, r5, r15\n\
1625 add r4, r4, r11\n\
1626 sub r5, r5, r16\n\
1627 @end smallexample\n\
1629 Now peephole2 pass can simply merge the two pairs of loads.\n\
1631 Since scheduling fusion pass relies on peephole2 to do real fusion\n\
1632 work, it is only enabled by default when peephole2 is in effect.\n\
1634 This is firstly introduced on ARM/AArch64 targets, please refer to\n\
1635 the hook implementation for how different fusion types are supported.",
1636 void, (rtx_insn *insn, int max_pri, int *fusion_pri, int *pri), NULL)
1638 HOOK_VECTOR_END (sched)
1640 /* Functions relating to OpenMP SIMD and __attribute__((simd)) clones. */
1641 #undef HOOK_PREFIX
1642 #define HOOK_PREFIX "TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_"
1643 HOOK_VECTOR (TARGET_SIMD_CLONE, simd_clone)
1645 DEFHOOK
1646 (compute_vecsize_and_simdlen,
1647 "This hook should set @var{vecsize_mangle}, @var{vecsize_int}, @var{vecsize_float}\n\
1648 fields in @var{simd_clone} structure pointed by @var{clone_info} argument and also\n\
1649 @var{simdlen} field if it was previously 0.\n\
1650 The hook should return 0 if SIMD clones shouldn't be emitted,\n\
1651 or number of @var{vecsize_mangle} variants that should be emitted.",
1652 int, (struct cgraph_node *, struct cgraph_simd_clone *, tree, int), NULL)
1654 DEFHOOK
1655 (adjust,
1656 "This hook should add implicit @code{attribute(target(\"...\"))} attribute\n\
1657 to SIMD clone @var{node} if needed.",
1658 void, (struct cgraph_node *), NULL)
1660 DEFHOOK
1661 (usable,
1662 "This hook should return -1 if SIMD clone @var{node} shouldn't be used\n\
1663 in vectorized loops in current function, or non-negative number if it is\n\
1664 usable. In that case, the smaller the number is, the more desirable it is\n\
1665 to use it.",
1666 int, (struct cgraph_node *), NULL)
1668 HOOK_VECTOR_END (simd_clone)
1670 /* Functions relating to OpenMP SIMT vectorization transform. */
1671 #undef HOOK_PREFIX
1672 #define HOOK_PREFIX "TARGET_SIMT_"
1673 HOOK_VECTOR (TARGET_SIMT, simt)
1675 DEFHOOK
1676 (vf,
1677 "Return number of threads in SIMT thread group on the target.",
1678 int, (void), NULL)
1680 HOOK_VECTOR_END (simt)
1682 /* Functions relating to openacc. */
1683 #undef HOOK_PREFIX
1684 #define HOOK_PREFIX "TARGET_GOACC_"
1685 HOOK_VECTOR (TARGET_GOACC, goacc)
1687 DEFHOOK
1688 (validate_dims,
1689 "This hook should check the launch dimensions provided for an OpenACC\n\
1690 compute region, or routine. Defaulted values are represented as -1\n\
1691 and non-constant values as 0. The @var{fn_level} is negative for the\n\
1692 function corresponding to the compute region. For a routine is is the\n\
1693 outermost level at which partitioned execution may be spawned. The hook\n\
1694 should verify non-default values. If DECL is NULL, global defaults\n\
1695 are being validated and unspecified defaults should be filled in.\n\
1696 Diagnostics should be issued as appropriate. Return\n\
1697 true, if changes have been made. You must override this hook to\n\
1698 provide dimensions larger than 1.",
1699 bool, (tree decl, int *dims, int fn_level),
1700 default_goacc_validate_dims)
1702 DEFHOOK
1703 (dim_limit,
1704 "This hook should return the maximum size of a particular dimension,\n\
1705 or zero if unbounded.",
1706 int, (int axis),
1707 default_goacc_dim_limit)
1709 DEFHOOK
1710 (fork_join,
1711 "This hook can be used to convert IFN_GOACC_FORK and IFN_GOACC_JOIN\n\
1712 function calls to target-specific gimple, or indicate whether they\n\
1713 should be retained. It is executed during the oacc_device_lower pass.\n\
1714 It should return true, if the call should be retained. It should\n\
1715 return false, if it is to be deleted (either because target-specific\n\
1716 gimple has been inserted before it, or there is no need for it).\n\
1717 The default hook returns false, if there are no RTL expanders for them.",
1718 bool, (gcall *call, const int *dims, bool is_fork),
1719 default_goacc_fork_join)
1721 DEFHOOK
1722 (reduction,
1723 "This hook is used by the oacc_transform pass to expand calls to the\n\
1724 @var{GOACC_REDUCTION} internal function, into a sequence of gimple\n\
1725 instructions. @var{call} is gimple statement containing the call to\n\
1726 the function. This hook removes statement @var{call} after the\n\
1727 expanded sequence has been inserted. This hook is also responsible\n\
1728 for allocating any storage for reductions when necessary.",
1729 void, (gcall *call),
1730 default_goacc_reduction)
1732 HOOK_VECTOR_END (goacc)
1734 /* Functions relating to vectorization. */
1735 #undef HOOK_PREFIX
1736 #define HOOK_PREFIX "TARGET_VECTORIZE_"
1737 HOOK_VECTOR (TARGET_VECTORIZE, vectorize)
1739 /* The following member value is a pointer to a function called
1740 by the vectorizer, and return the decl of the target builtin
1741 function. */
1742 DEFHOOK
1743 (builtin_mask_for_load,
1744 "This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an\n\
1745 address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be\n\
1746 used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in\n\
1747 @var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.\n\
1749 The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address\n\
1750 @var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from\n\
1751 the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a\n\
1752 @code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the\n\
1753 two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},\n\
1754 @var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and\n\
1755 the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted\n\
1756 from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is\n\
1757 @var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last\n\
1758 @var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first\n\
1759 @var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.\n\
1761 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call\n\
1762 to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will\n\
1763 use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to\n\
1764 @code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}\n\
1765 should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}\n\
1766 described above.\n\
1767 If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as\n\
1768 the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low\n\
1769 log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.",
1770 tree, (void), NULL)
1772 /* Returns a built-in function that realizes the vectorized version of
1773 a target-independent function, or NULL_TREE if not available. */
1774 DEFHOOK
1775 (builtin_vectorized_function,
1776 "This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the\n\
1777 vectorized variant of the function with the @code{combined_fn} code\n\
1778 @var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.\n\
1779 The return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type\n\
1780 @var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.",
1781 tree, (unsigned code, tree vec_type_out, tree vec_type_in),
1782 default_builtin_vectorized_function)
1784 /* Returns a built-in function that realizes the vectorized version of
1785 a target-specific function, or NULL_TREE if not available. */
1786 DEFHOOK
1787 (builtin_md_vectorized_function,
1788 "This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the\n\
1789 vectorized variant of target built-in function @code{fndecl}. The\n\
1790 return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type\n\
1791 @var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.",
1792 tree, (tree fndecl, tree vec_type_out, tree vec_type_in),
1793 default_builtin_md_vectorized_function)
1795 /* Returns a function declaration for a builtin that realizes the
1796 vector conversion, or NULL_TREE if not available. */
1797 DEFHOOK
1798 (builtin_conversion,
1799 "This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the\n\
1800 input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.\n\
1801 The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and\n\
1802 specifies how the conversion is to be applied\n\
1803 (truncation, rounding, etc.).\n\
1805 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the\n\
1806 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing\n\
1807 conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.",
1808 tree, (unsigned code, tree dest_type, tree src_type),
1809 default_builtin_vectorized_conversion)
1811 /* Cost of different vector/scalar statements in vectorization cost
1812 model. In case of misaligned vector loads and stores the cost depends
1813 on the data type and misalignment value. */
1814 DEFHOOK
1815 (builtin_vectorization_cost,
1816 "Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.\n\
1817 For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and\n\
1818 misalignment value (@var{misalign}).",
1819 int, (enum vect_cost_for_stmt type_of_cost, tree vectype, int misalign),
1820 default_builtin_vectorization_cost)
1822 DEFHOOK
1823 (preferred_vector_alignment,
1824 "This hook returns the preferred alignment in bits for accesses to\n\
1825 vectors of type @var{type} in vectorized code. This might be less than\n\
1826 or greater than the ABI-defined value returned by\n\
1827 @code{TARGET_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT}. It can be equal to the alignment of\n\
1828 a single element, in which case the vectorizer will not try to optimize\n\
1829 for alignment.\n\
1831 The default hook returns @code{TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type})}, which is\n\
1832 correct for most targets.",
1833 HOST_WIDE_INT, (const_tree type),
1834 default_preferred_vector_alignment)
1836 /* Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N
1837 iterations) for the given scalar type. */
1838 DEFHOOK
1839 (vector_alignment_reachable,
1840 "Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given scalar type @var{type}. @var{is_packed} is false if the scalar access using @var{type} is known to be naturally aligned.",
1841 bool, (const_tree type, bool is_packed),
1842 default_builtin_vector_alignment_reachable)
1844 DEFHOOK
1845 (vec_perm_const,
1846 "This hook is used to test whether the target can permute up to two\n\
1847 vectors of mode @var{mode} using the permutation vector @code{sel}, and\n\
1848 also to emit such a permutation. In the former case @var{in0}, @var{in1}\n\
1849 and @var{out} are all null. In the latter case @var{in0} and @var{in1} are\n\
1850 the source vectors and @var{out} is the destination vector; all three are\n\
1851 registers of mode @var{mode}. @var{in1} is the same as @var{in0} if\n\
1852 @var{sel} describes a permutation on one vector instead of two.\n\
1854 Return true if the operation is possible, emitting instructions for it\n\
1855 if rtxes are provided.\n\
1857 @cindex @code{vec_perm@var{m}} instruction pattern\n\
1858 If the hook returns false for a mode with multibyte elements, GCC will\n\
1859 try the equivalent byte operation. If that also fails, it will try forcing\n\
1860 the selector into a register and using the @var{vec_perm@var{mode}}\n\
1861 instruction pattern. There is no need for the hook to handle these two\n\
1862 implementation approaches itself.",
1863 bool, (machine_mode mode, rtx output, rtx in0, rtx in1,
1864 const vec_perm_indices &sel),
1865 NULL)
1867 /* Return true if the target supports misaligned store/load of a
1868 specific factor denoted in the third parameter. The last parameter
1869 is true if the access is defined in a packed struct. */
1870 DEFHOOK
1871 (support_vector_misalignment,
1872 "This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector\n\
1873 store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}\n\
1874 parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and\n\
1875 the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}\n\
1876 parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.",
1877 bool,
1878 (machine_mode mode, const_tree type, int misalignment, bool is_packed),
1879 default_builtin_support_vector_misalignment)
1881 /* Returns the preferred mode for SIMD operations for the specified
1882 scalar mode. */
1883 DEFHOOK
1884 (preferred_simd_mode,
1885 "This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar\n\
1886 mode @var{mode}. The default is\n\
1887 equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some\n\
1888 transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.",
1889 machine_mode,
1890 (scalar_mode mode),
1891 default_preferred_simd_mode)
1893 /* Returns the preferred mode for splitting SIMD reductions to. */
1894 DEFHOOK
1895 (split_reduction,
1896 "This hook should return the preferred mode to split the final reduction\n\
1897 step on @var{mode} to. The reduction is then carried out reducing upper\n\
1898 against lower halves of vectors recursively until the specified mode is\n\
1899 reached. The default is @var{mode} which means no splitting.",
1900 machine_mode,
1901 (machine_mode),
1902 default_split_reduction)
1904 /* Returns a mask of vector sizes to iterate over when auto-vectorizing
1905 after processing the preferred one derived from preferred_simd_mode. */
1906 DEFHOOK
1907 (autovectorize_vector_sizes,
1908 "If the mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE} is not\n\
1909 the only one that is worth considering, this hook should add all suitable\n\
1910 vector sizes to @var{sizes}, in order of decreasing preference. The first\n\
1911 one should be the size of @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.\n\
1913 The hook does not need to do anything if the vector returned by\n\
1914 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE} is the only one relevant\n\
1915 for autovectorization. The default implementation does nothing.",
1916 void,
1917 (vector_sizes *sizes),
1918 default_autovectorize_vector_sizes)
1920 /* Function to get a target mode for a vector mask. */
1921 DEFHOOK
1922 (get_mask_mode,
1923 "A vector mask is a value that holds one boolean result for every element\n\
1924 in a vector. This hook returns the machine mode that should be used to\n\
1925 represent such a mask when the vector in question is @var{length} bytes\n\
1926 long and contains @var{nunits} elements. The hook returns an empty\n\
1927 @code{opt_machine_mode} if no such mode exists.\n\
1929 The default implementation returns the mode of an integer vector that\n\
1930 is @var{length} bytes long and that contains @var{nunits} elements,\n\
1931 if such a mode exists.",
1932 opt_machine_mode,
1933 (poly_uint64 nunits, poly_uint64 length),
1934 default_get_mask_mode)
1936 /* Target builtin that implements vector gather operation. */
1937 DEFHOOK
1938 (builtin_gather,
1939 "Target builtin that implements vector gather operation. @var{mem_vectype}\n\
1940 is the vector type of the load and @var{index_type} is scalar type of\n\
1941 the index, scaled by @var{scale}.\n\
1942 The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize gather\n\
1943 loads.",
1944 tree,
1945 (const_tree mem_vectype, const_tree index_type, int scale),
1946 NULL)
1948 /* Target builtin that implements vector scatter operation. */
1949 DEFHOOK
1950 (builtin_scatter,
1951 "Target builtin that implements vector scatter operation. @var{vectype}\n\
1952 is the vector type of the store and @var{index_type} is scalar type of\n\
1953 the index, scaled by @var{scale}.\n\
1954 The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize scatter\n\
1955 stores.",
1956 tree,
1957 (const_tree vectype, const_tree index_type, int scale),
1958 NULL)
1960 /* Target function to initialize the cost model for a loop or block. */
1961 DEFHOOK
1962 (init_cost,
1963 "This hook should initialize target-specific data structures in preparation "
1964 "for modeling the costs of vectorizing a loop or basic block. The default "
1965 "allocates three unsigned integers for accumulating costs for the prologue, "
1966 "body, and epilogue of the loop or basic block. If @var{loop_info} is "
1967 "non-NULL, it identifies the loop being vectorized; otherwise a single block "
1968 "is being vectorized.",
1969 void *,
1970 (struct loop *loop_info),
1971 default_init_cost)
1973 /* Target function to record N statements of the given kind using the
1974 given vector type within the cost model data for the current loop or
1975 block. */
1976 DEFHOOK
1977 (add_stmt_cost,
1978 "This hook should update the target-specific @var{data} in response to "
1979 "adding @var{count} copies of the given @var{kind} of statement to a "
1980 "loop or basic block. The default adds the builtin vectorizer cost for "
1981 "the copies of the statement to the accumulator specified by @var{where}, "
1982 "(the prologue, body, or epilogue) and returns the amount added. The "
1983 "return value should be viewed as a tentative cost that may later be "
1984 "revised.",
1985 unsigned,
1986 (void *data, int count, enum vect_cost_for_stmt kind,
1987 struct _stmt_vec_info *stmt_info, int misalign,
1988 enum vect_cost_model_location where),
1989 default_add_stmt_cost)
1991 /* Target function to calculate the total cost of the current vectorized
1992 loop or block. */
1993 DEFHOOK
1994 (finish_cost,
1995 "This hook should complete calculations of the cost of vectorizing a loop "
1996 "or basic block based on @var{data}, and return the prologue, body, and "
1997 "epilogue costs as unsigned integers. The default returns the value of "
1998 "the three accumulators.",
1999 void,
2000 (void *data, unsigned *prologue_cost, unsigned *body_cost,
2001 unsigned *epilogue_cost),
2002 default_finish_cost)
2004 /* Function to delete target-specific cost modeling data. */
2005 DEFHOOK
2006 (destroy_cost_data,
2007 "This hook should release @var{data} and any related data structures "
2008 "allocated by TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST. The default releases the "
2009 "accumulator.",
2010 void,
2011 (void *data),
2012 default_destroy_cost_data)
2014 HOOK_VECTOR_END (vectorize)
2016 #undef HOOK_PREFIX
2017 #define HOOK_PREFIX "TARGET_"
2019 DEFHOOK
2020 (record_offload_symbol,
2021 "Used when offloaded functions are seen in the compilation unit and no named\n\
2022 sections are available. It is called once for each symbol that must be\n\
2023 recorded in the offload function and variable table.",
2024 void, (tree),
2025 hook_void_tree)
2027 DEFHOOKPOD
2028 (absolute_biggest_alignment,
2029 "If defined, this target hook specifies the absolute biggest alignment\n\
2030 that a type or variable can have on this machine, otherwise,\n\
2031 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} is used.",
2032 HOST_WIDE_INT, BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT)
2034 /* Allow target specific overriding of option settings after options have
2035 been changed by an attribute or pragma or when it is reset at the
2036 end of the code affected by an attribute or pragma. */
2037 DEFHOOK
2038 (override_options_after_change,
2039 "This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}\n\
2040 but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or\n\
2041 pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the\n\
2042 attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation\n\
2043 when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these\n\
2044 actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call\n\
2045 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.",
2046 void, (void),
2047 hook_void_void)
2049 DEFHOOK
2050 (offload_options,
2051 "Used when writing out the list of options into an LTO file. It should\n\
2052 translate any relevant target-specific options (such as the ABI in use)\n\
2053 into one of the @option{-foffload} options that exist as a common interface\n\
2054 to express such options. It should return a string containing these options,\n\
2055 separated by spaces, which the caller will free.\n",
2056 char *, (void), hook_charptr_void_null)
2058 DEFHOOK_UNDOC
2059 (eh_return_filter_mode,
2060 "Return machine mode for filter value.",
2061 scalar_int_mode, (void),
2062 default_eh_return_filter_mode)
2064 /* Return machine mode for libgcc expanded cmp instructions. */
2065 DEFHOOK
2066 (libgcc_cmp_return_mode,
2067 "This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value\n\
2068 of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined\n\
2069 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of\n\
2070 targets.",
2071 scalar_int_mode, (void),
2072 default_libgcc_cmp_return_mode)
2074 /* Return machine mode for libgcc expanded shift instructions. */
2075 DEFHOOK
2076 (libgcc_shift_count_mode,
2077 "This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand\n\
2078 of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined\n\
2079 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of\n\
2080 targets.",
2081 scalar_int_mode, (void),
2082 default_libgcc_shift_count_mode)
2084 /* Return machine mode to be used for _Unwind_Word type. */
2085 DEFHOOK
2086 (unwind_word_mode,
2087 "Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.\n\
2088 The default is to use @code{word_mode}.",
2089 scalar_int_mode, (void),
2090 default_unwind_word_mode)
2092 /* Given two decls, merge their attributes and return the result. */
2093 DEFHOOK
2094 (merge_decl_attributes,
2095 "Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special\n\
2096 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined\n\
2097 @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.\n\
2098 @var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of\n\
2099 when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an\n\
2100 attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may\n\
2101 call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.\n\
2103 @findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES\n\
2104 If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}\n\
2105 for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro\n\
2106 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler\n\
2107 will then define a function called\n\
2108 @code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as\n\
2109 the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also\n\
2110 add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port\n\
2111 to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and\n\
2112 @samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and\n\
2113 @file{i386/i386.c}, for example.",
2114 tree, (tree olddecl, tree newdecl),
2115 merge_decl_attributes)
2117 /* Given two types, merge their attributes and return the result. */
2118 DEFHOOK
2119 (merge_type_attributes,
2120 "Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special\n\
2121 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined\n\
2122 @code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed\n\
2123 that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This\n\
2124 function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent\n\
2125 merging.",
2126 tree, (tree type1, tree type2),
2127 merge_type_attributes)
2129 /* Table of machine attributes and functions to handle them.
2130 Ignored if NULL. */
2131 DEFHOOKPOD
2132 (attribute_table,
2133 "If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct\n\
2134 attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree-core.h}) specifying the machine\n\
2135 specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the\n\
2136 entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they\n\
2137 take.",
2138 const struct attribute_spec *, NULL)
2140 /* Return true iff attribute NAME expects a plain identifier as its first
2141 argument. */
2142 DEFHOOK
2143 (attribute_takes_identifier_p,
2144 "If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the\n\
2145 machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier\n\
2146 given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not\n\
2147 subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is\n\
2148 false for all machine-specific attributes.",
2149 bool, (const_tree name),
2150 hook_bool_const_tree_false)
2152 /* Return zero if the attributes on TYPE1 and TYPE2 are incompatible,
2153 one if they are compatible and two if they are nearly compatible
2154 (which causes a warning to be generated). */
2155 DEFHOOK
2156 (comp_type_attributes,
2157 "If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on\n\
2158 @var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,\n\
2159 and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be\n\
2160 generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are\n\
2161 supposed always to be compatible.",
2162 int, (const_tree type1, const_tree type2),
2163 hook_int_const_tree_const_tree_1)
2165 /* Assign default attributes to the newly defined TYPE. */
2166 DEFHOOK
2167 (set_default_type_attributes,
2168 "If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to\n\
2169 the newly defined @var{type}.",
2170 void, (tree type),
2171 hook_void_tree)
2173 /* Insert attributes on the newly created DECL. */
2174 DEFHOOK
2175 (insert_attributes,
2176 "Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl\n\
2177 when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which\n\
2178 wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to\n\
2179 the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being\n\
2180 created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list\n\
2181 for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be\n\
2182 shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of\n\
2183 the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new\n\
2184 attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are\n\
2185 needed.",
2186 void, (tree node, tree *attr_ptr),
2187 hook_void_tree_treeptr)
2189 /* Return true if FNDECL (which has at least one machine attribute)
2190 can be inlined despite its machine attributes, false otherwise. */
2191 DEFHOOK
2192 (function_attribute_inlinable_p,
2193 "@cindex inlining\n\
2194 This target hook returns @code{true} if it is OK to inline @var{fndecl}\n\
2195 into the current function, despite its having target-specific\n\
2196 attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a\n\
2197 target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.",
2198 bool, (const_tree fndecl),
2199 hook_bool_const_tree_false)
2201 /* Return true if bitfields in RECORD_TYPE should follow the
2202 Microsoft Visual C++ bitfield layout rules. */
2203 DEFHOOK
2204 (ms_bitfield_layout_p,
2205 "This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given\n\
2206 @var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft\n\
2207 Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage\n\
2208 unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have\n\
2209 different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest\n\
2210 alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous\n\
2211 bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of\n\
2212 the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that\n\
2213 (iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows\n\
2214 another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},\n\
2215 other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.\n\
2217 When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size\n\
2218 of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent\n\
2219 bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,\n\
2220 and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same\n\
2221 chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that\n\
2222 size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using\n\
2223 alignment, but not equivalent when packing.\n\
2225 If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,\n\
2226 the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is\n\
2227 used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take\n\
2228 precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure\n\
2229 may affect its placement.",
2230 bool, (const_tree record_type),
2231 hook_bool_const_tree_false)
2233 /* For now this is only an interface to WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN for
2234 target-independent code like the front ends, need performance testing
2235 before switching completely to the target hook. */
2236 DEFHOOK_UNDOC
2237 (words_big_endian,
2239 bool, (void),
2240 targhook_words_big_endian)
2242 /* Likewise for FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN. */
2243 DEFHOOK_UNDOC
2244 (float_words_big_endian,
2246 bool, (void),
2247 targhook_float_words_big_endian)
2249 DEFHOOK
2250 (float_exceptions_rounding_supported_p,
2251 "Returns true if the target supports IEEE 754 floating-point exceptions\
2252 and rounding modes, false otherwise. This is intended to relate to the\
2253 @code{float} and @code{double} types, but not necessarily @code{long double}.\
2254 By default, returns true if the @code{adddf3} instruction pattern is\
2255 available and false otherwise, on the assumption that hardware floating\
2256 point supports exceptions and rounding modes but software floating point\
2257 does not.",
2258 bool, (void),
2259 default_float_exceptions_rounding_supported_p)
2261 /* True if the target supports decimal floating point. */
2262 DEFHOOK
2263 (decimal_float_supported_p,
2264 "Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.",
2265 bool, (void),
2266 default_decimal_float_supported_p)
2268 /* True if the target supports fixed-point. */
2269 DEFHOOK
2270 (fixed_point_supported_p,
2271 "Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.",
2272 bool, (void),
2273 default_fixed_point_supported_p)
2275 /* Return true if anonymous bitfields affect structure alignment. */
2276 DEFHOOK
2277 (align_anon_bitfield,
2278 "When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine\n\
2279 whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing\n\
2280 structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit\n\
2281 the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.",
2282 bool, (void),
2283 hook_bool_void_false)
2285 /* Return true if volatile bitfields should use the narrowest type possible.
2286 Return false if they should use the container type. */
2287 DEFHOOK
2288 (narrow_volatile_bitfield,
2289 "This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields\n\
2290 should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if\n\
2291 these accesses should use the bitfield container type.\n\
2293 The default is @code{false}.",
2294 bool, (void),
2295 hook_bool_void_false)
2297 /* Set up target-specific built-in functions. */
2298 DEFHOOK
2299 (init_builtins,
2300 "Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions\n\
2301 that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the\n\
2302 necessary setup.\n\
2304 Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine\n\
2305 instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because\n\
2306 they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector\n\
2307 instructions or prefetch instructions).\n\
2309 To create a built-in function, call the function\n\
2310 @code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}\n\
2311 which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set\n\
2312 up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes};\n\
2313 only language front ends that use those two functions will call\n\
2314 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.",
2315 void, (void),
2316 hook_void_void)
2318 /* Initialize (if INITIALIZE_P is true) and return the target-specific
2319 built-in function decl for CODE.
2320 Return NULL if that is not possible. Return error_mark_node if CODE
2321 is outside of the range of valid target builtin function codes. */
2322 DEFHOOK
2323 (builtin_decl,
2324 "Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions\n\
2325 that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the\n\
2326 builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.\n\
2327 If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time\n\
2328 if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.\n\
2329 If @var{code} is out of range the function should return\n\
2330 @code{error_mark_node}.",
2331 tree, (unsigned code, bool initialize_p), NULL)
2333 /* Expand a target-specific builtin. */
2334 DEFHOOK
2335 (expand_builtin,
2336 "\n\
2337 Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by\n\
2338 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the\n\
2339 function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is\n\
2340 convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.\n\
2341 @var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of\n\
2342 @var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be\n\
2343 ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the\n\
2344 built-in function.",
2345 rtx,
2346 (tree exp, rtx target, rtx subtarget, machine_mode mode, int ignore),
2347 default_expand_builtin)
2349 DEFHOOK
2350 (builtin_chkp_function,
2351 "This hook allows target to redefine built-in functions used by\n\
2352 Pointer Bounds Checker for code instrumentation. Hook should return\n\
2353 fndecl of function implementing generic builtin whose code is\n\
2354 passed in @var{fcode}. Currently following built-in functions are\n\
2355 obtained using this hook:\n\
2356 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_bndmk (const void *@var{lb}, size_t @var{size})\n\
2357 Function code - BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDMK. This built-in function is used\n\
2358 by Pointer Bounds Checker to create bound values. @var{lb} holds low\n\
2359 bound of the resulting bounds. @var{size} holds size of created bounds.\n\
2360 @end deftypefn\n\
2362 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} void __chkp_bndstx (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b}, const void **@var{loc})\n\
2363 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDSTX}. This built-in function is used\n\
2364 by Pointer Bounds Checker to store bounds @var{b} for pointer @var{ptr}\n\
2365 when @var{ptr} is stored by address @var{loc}.\n\
2366 @end deftypefn\n\
2368 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_bndldx (const void **@var{loc}, const void *@var{ptr})\n\
2369 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDLDX}. This built-in function is used\n\
2370 by Pointer Bounds Checker to get bounds of pointer @var{ptr} loaded by\n\
2371 address @var{loc}.\n\
2372 @end deftypefn\n\
2374 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} void __chkp_bndcl (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b})\n\
2375 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDCL}. This built-in function is used\n\
2376 by Pointer Bounds Checker to perform check for pointer @var{ptr} against\n\
2377 lower bound of bounds @var{b}.\n\
2378 @end deftypefn\n\
2380 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} void __chkp_bndcu (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b})\n\
2381 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDCU}. This built-in function is used\n\
2382 by Pointer Bounds Checker to perform check for pointer @var{ptr} against\n\
2383 upper bound of bounds @var{b}.\n\
2384 @end deftypefn\n\
2386 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_bndret (void *@var{ptr})\n\
2387 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDRET}. This built-in function is used\n\
2388 by Pointer Bounds Checker to obtain bounds returned by a call statement.\n\
2389 @var{ptr} passed to built-in is @code{SSA_NAME} returned by the call.\n\
2390 @end deftypefn\n\
2392 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_intersect (__bounds_type @var{b1}, __bounds_type @var{b2})\n\
2393 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_INTERSECT}. This built-in function\n\
2394 returns intersection of bounds @var{b1} and @var{b2}.\n\
2395 @end deftypefn\n\
2397 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_narrow (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b}, size_t @var{s})\n\
2398 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_NARROW}. This built-in function\n\
2399 returns intersection of bounds @var{b} and\n\
2400 [@var{ptr}, @var{ptr} + @var{s} - @code{1}].\n\
2401 @end deftypefn\n\
2403 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} size_t __chkp_sizeof (const void *@var{ptr})\n\
2404 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_SIZEOF}. This built-in function\n\
2405 returns size of object referenced by @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} is always\n\
2406 @code{ADDR_EXPR} of @code{VAR_DECL}. This built-in is used by\n\
2407 Pointer Bounds Checker when bounds of object cannot be computed statically\n\
2408 (e.g. object has incomplete type).\n\
2409 @end deftypefn\n\
2411 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} const void *__chkp_extract_lower (__bounds_type @var{b})\n\
2412 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_EXTRACT_LOWER}. This built-in function\n\
2413 returns lower bound of bounds @var{b}.\n\
2414 @end deftypefn\n\
2416 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} const void *__chkp_extract_upper (__bounds_type @var{b})\n\
2417 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_EXTRACT_UPPER}. This built-in function\n\
2418 returns upper bound of bounds @var{b}.\n\
2419 @end deftypefn",
2420 tree, (unsigned fcode),
2421 default_builtin_chkp_function)
2423 DEFHOOK
2424 (chkp_bound_type,
2425 "Return type to be used for bounds",
2426 tree, (void),
2427 default_chkp_bound_type)
2429 DEFHOOK
2430 (chkp_bound_mode,
2431 "Return mode to be used for bounds.",
2432 machine_mode, (void),
2433 default_chkp_bound_mode)
2435 DEFHOOK
2436 (chkp_make_bounds_constant,
2437 "Return constant used to statically initialize constant bounds\n\
2438 with specified lower bound @var{lb} and upper bounds @var{ub}.",
2439 tree, (HOST_WIDE_INT lb, HOST_WIDE_INT ub),
2440 default_chkp_make_bounds_constant)
2442 DEFHOOK
2443 (chkp_initialize_bounds,
2444 "Generate a list of statements @var{stmts} to initialize pointer\n\
2445 bounds variable @var{var} with bounds @var{lb} and @var{ub}. Return\n\
2446 the number of generated statements.",
2447 int, (tree var, tree lb, tree ub, tree *stmts),
2448 default_chkp_initialize_bounds)
2450 /* Select a replacement for a target-specific builtin. This is done
2451 *before* regular type checking, and so allows the target to
2452 implement a crude form of function overloading. The result is a
2453 complete expression that implements the operation. PARAMS really
2454 has type VEC(tree,gc)*, but we don't want to include tree.h here. */
2455 DEFHOOK
2456 (resolve_overloaded_builtin,
2457 "Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that\n\
2458 was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done\n\
2459 @emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to\n\
2460 implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the\n\
2461 declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of\n\
2462 arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a\n\
2463 complete expression that implements the operation, usually\n\
2464 another @code{CALL_EXPR}.\n\
2465 @var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}",
2466 tree, (unsigned int /*location_t*/ loc, tree fndecl, void *arglist), NULL)
2468 /* Fold a target-specific builtin to a tree valid for both GIMPLE
2469 and GENERIC. */
2470 DEFHOOK
2471 (fold_builtin,
2472 "Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by\n\
2473 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the\n\
2474 built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to\n\
2475 the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.\n\
2476 The result is another tree, valid for both GIMPLE and GENERIC,\n\
2477 containing a simplified expression for the call's result. If\n\
2478 @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.",
2479 tree, (tree fndecl, int n_args, tree *argp, bool ignore),
2480 hook_tree_tree_int_treep_bool_null)
2482 /* Fold a target-specific builtin to a valid GIMPLE tree. */
2483 DEFHOOK
2484 (gimple_fold_builtin,
2485 "Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up\n\
2486 by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{gsi} points to the gimple\n\
2487 statement holding the function call. Returns true if any change\n\
2488 was made to the GIMPLE stream.",
2489 bool, (gimple_stmt_iterator *gsi),
2490 hook_bool_gsiptr_false)
2492 /* Target hook is used to compare the target attributes in two functions to
2493 determine which function's features get higher priority. This is used
2494 during function multi-versioning to figure out the order in which two
2495 versions must be dispatched. A function version with a higher priority
2496 is checked for dispatching earlier. DECL1 and DECL2 are
2497 the two function decls that will be compared. It returns positive value
2498 if DECL1 is higher priority, negative value if DECL2 is higher priority
2499 and 0 if they are the same. */
2500 DEFHOOK
2501 (compare_version_priority,
2502 "This hook is used to compare the target attributes in two functions to\n\
2503 determine which function's features get higher priority. This is used\n\
2504 during function multi-versioning to figure out the order in which two\n\
2505 versions must be dispatched. A function version with a higher priority\n\
2506 is checked for dispatching earlier. @var{decl1} and @var{decl2} are\n\
2507 the two function decls that will be compared.",
2508 int, (tree decl1, tree decl2), NULL)
2510 /* Target hook is used to generate the dispatcher logic to invoke the right
2511 function version at run-time for a given set of function versions.
2512 ARG points to the callgraph node of the dispatcher function whose body
2513 must be generated. */
2514 DEFHOOK
2515 (generate_version_dispatcher_body,
2516 "This hook is used to generate the dispatcher logic to invoke the right\n\
2517 function version at run-time for a given set of function versions.\n\
2518 @var{arg} points to the callgraph node of the dispatcher function whose\n\
2519 body must be generated.",
2520 tree, (void *arg), NULL)
2522 /* Target hook is used to get the dispatcher function for a set of function
2523 versions. The dispatcher function is called to invoke the right function
2524 version at run-time. DECL is one version from a set of semantically
2525 identical versions. */
2526 DEFHOOK
2527 (get_function_versions_dispatcher,
2528 "This hook is used to get the dispatcher function for a set of function\n\
2529 versions. The dispatcher function is called to invoke the right function\n\
2530 version at run-time. @var{decl} is one version from a set of semantically\n\
2531 identical versions.",
2532 tree, (void *decl), NULL)
2534 /* Returns a code for a target-specific builtin that implements
2535 reciprocal of a target-specific function, or NULL_TREE if not available. */
2536 DEFHOOK
2537 (builtin_reciprocal,
2538 "This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements the\n\
2539 reciprocal of the machine-specific builtin function @var{fndecl}, or\n\
2540 @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.",
2541 tree, (tree fndecl),
2542 default_builtin_reciprocal)
2544 /* For a vendor-specific TYPE, return a pointer to a statically-allocated
2545 string containing the C++ mangling for TYPE. In all other cases, return
2546 NULL. */
2547 DEFHOOK
2548 (mangle_type,
2549 "If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target\n\
2550 uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook\n\
2551 to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++\n\
2552 mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing\n\
2553 the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are\n\
2554 not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}\n\
2555 for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the\n\
2556 return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated\n\
2557 string constant.\n\
2559 Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or\n\
2560 qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new\n\
2561 fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}\n\
2562 is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the\n\
2563 length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of\n\
2564 ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where\n\
2565 @var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,\n\
2566 @var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the\n\
2567 code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See\n\
2568 @code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of\n\
2569 codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any\n\
2570 spaces in your string.\n\
2572 This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled\n\
2573 name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you\n\
2574 can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}\n\
2575 before mangling.\n\
2577 The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is\n\
2578 appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental\n\
2579 types.",
2580 const char *, (const_tree type),
2581 hook_constcharptr_const_tree_null)
2583 /* Make any adjustments to libfunc names needed for this target. */
2584 DEFHOOK
2585 (init_libfuncs,
2586 "This hook should declare additional library routines or rename\n\
2587 existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and\n\
2588 @code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.\n\
2589 @code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal\n\
2590 library routines.\n\
2592 The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.",
2593 void, (void),
2594 hook_void_void)
2596 /* Add a __gnu_ prefix to library functions rather than just __. */
2597 DEFHOOKPOD
2598 (libfunc_gnu_prefix,
2599 "If false (the default), internal library routines start with two\n\
2600 underscores. If set to true, these routines start with @code{__gnu_}\n\
2601 instead. E.g., @code{__muldi3} changes to @code{__gnu_muldi3}. This\n\
2602 currently only affects functions defined in @file{libgcc2.c}. If this\n\
2603 is set to true, the @file{tm.h} file must also\n\
2604 @code{#define LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX}.",
2605 bool, false)
2607 /* Given a decl, a section name, and whether the decl initializer
2608 has relocs, choose attributes for the section. */
2609 /* ??? Should be merged with SELECT_SECTION and UNIQUE_SECTION. */
2610 DEFHOOK
2611 (section_type_flags,
2612 "Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}\n\
2613 based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the\n\
2614 declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be\n\
2615 null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.\n\
2617 The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,\n\
2618 read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only\n\
2619 need to override this if your target has special flags that might be\n\
2620 set via @code{__attribute__}.",
2621 unsigned int, (tree decl, const char *name, int reloc),
2622 default_section_type_flags)
2624 DEFHOOK
2625 (libc_has_function,
2626 "This hook determines whether a function from a class of functions\n\
2627 @var{fn_class} is present at the runtime.",
2628 bool, (enum function_class fn_class),
2629 default_libc_has_function)
2631 /* True if new jumps cannot be created, to replace existing ones or
2632 not, at the current point in the compilation. */
2633 DEFHOOK
2634 (cannot_modify_jumps_p,
2635 "This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump\n\
2636 instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for\n\
2637 every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be\n\
2638 reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:\n\
2640 @smallexample\n\
2641 static bool\n\
2642 cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()\n\
2643 @{\n\
2644 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);\n\
2645 @}\n\
2646 @end smallexample",
2647 bool, (void),
2648 hook_bool_void_false)
2650 /* True if FOLLOWER may be modified to follow FOLLOWEE. */
2651 DEFHOOK
2652 (can_follow_jump,
2653 "FOLLOWER and FOLLOWEE are JUMP_INSN instructions;\
2654 return true if FOLLOWER may be modified to follow FOLLOWEE;\
2655 false, if it can't.\
2656 For example, on some targets, certain kinds of branches can't be made to\
2657 follow through a hot/cold partitioning.",
2658 bool, (const rtx_insn *follower, const rtx_insn *followee),
2659 hook_bool_const_rtx_insn_const_rtx_insn_true)
2661 /* Return a register class for which branch target register
2662 optimizations should be applied. */
2663 DEFHOOK
2664 (branch_target_register_class,
2665 "This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register\n\
2666 optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be\n\
2667 usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be\n\
2668 re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected\n\
2669 to inter-block scheduling.",
2670 reg_class_t, (void),
2671 default_branch_target_register_class)
2673 /* Return true if branch target register optimizations should include
2674 callee-saved registers that are not already live during the current
2675 function. AFTER_PE_GEN is true if prologues and epilogues have
2676 already been generated. */
2677 DEFHOOK
2678 (branch_target_register_callee_saved,
2679 "Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved\n\
2680 registers\n\
2681 that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook\n\
2682 returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure\n\
2683 that all target registers in the class returned by\n\
2684 @samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are\n\
2685 saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and\n\
2686 epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return\n\
2687 true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely\n\
2688 to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}\n\
2689 to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.",
2690 bool, (bool after_prologue_epilogue_gen),
2691 hook_bool_bool_false)
2693 /* Return true if the target supports conditional execution. */
2694 DEFHOOK
2695 (have_conditional_execution,
2696 "This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.\n\
2697 This target hook is required only when the target has several different\n\
2698 modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.",
2699 bool, (void),
2700 default_have_conditional_execution)
2702 DEFHOOK
2703 (gen_ccmp_first,
2704 "This function prepares to emit a comparison insn for the first compare in a\n\
2705 sequence of conditional comparisions. It returns an appropriate comparison\n\
2706 with @code{CC} for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}.\n\
2707 The insns to prepare the compare are saved in @var{prep_seq} and the compare\n\
2708 insns are saved in @var{gen_seq}. They will be emitted when all the\n\
2709 compares in the the conditional comparision are generated without error.\n\
2710 @var{code} is the @code{rtx_code} of the compare for @var{op0} and @var{op1}.",
2711 rtx, (rtx_insn **prep_seq, rtx_insn **gen_seq, int code, tree op0, tree op1),
2712 NULL)
2714 DEFHOOK
2715 (gen_ccmp_next,
2716 "This function prepares to emit a conditional comparison within a sequence\n\
2717 of conditional comparisons. It returns an appropriate comparison with\n\
2718 @code{CC} for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}.\n\
2719 The insns to prepare the compare are saved in @var{prep_seq} and the compare\n\
2720 insns are saved in @var{gen_seq}. They will be emitted when all the\n\
2721 compares in the conditional comparision are generated without error. The\n\
2722 @var{prev} expression is the result of a prior call to @code{gen_ccmp_first}\n\
2723 or @code{gen_ccmp_next}. It may return @code{NULL} if the combination of\n\
2724 @var{prev} and this comparison is not supported, otherwise the result must\n\
2725 be appropriate for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}.\n\
2726 @var{code} is the @code{rtx_code} of the compare for @var{op0} and @var{op1}.\n\
2727 @var{bit_code} is @code{AND} or @code{IOR}, which is the op on the compares.",
2728 rtx, (rtx_insn **prep_seq, rtx_insn **gen_seq, rtx prev, int cmp_code, tree op0, tree op1, int bit_code),
2729 NULL)
2731 /* Return a new value for loop unroll size. */
2732 DEFHOOK
2733 (loop_unroll_adjust,
2734 "This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}\n\
2735 should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times\n\
2736 the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to\n\
2737 the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook\n\
2738 is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum\n\
2739 number of memory accesses.",
2740 unsigned, (unsigned nunroll, struct loop *loop),
2741 NULL)
2743 /* True if X is a legitimate MODE-mode immediate operand. */
2744 DEFHOOK
2745 (legitimate_constant_p,
2746 "This hook returns true if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for a\n\
2747 @var{mode}-mode immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that\n\
2748 @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.\n\
2750 The default definition returns true.",
2751 bool, (machine_mode mode, rtx x),
2752 hook_bool_mode_rtx_true)
2754 /* True if the constant X cannot be placed in the constant pool. */
2755 DEFHOOK
2756 (cannot_force_const_mem,
2757 "This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or\n\
2758 should not) be spilled to the constant pool. @var{mode} is the mode\n\
2759 of @var{x}.\n\
2761 The default version of this hook returns false.\n\
2763 The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from\n\
2764 deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded\n\
2765 from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register\n\
2766 holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses\n\
2767 of TLS symbols for various targets.",
2768 bool, (machine_mode mode, rtx x),
2769 hook_bool_mode_rtx_false)
2771 DEFHOOK_UNDOC
2772 (cannot_copy_insn_p,
2773 "True if the insn @var{x} cannot be duplicated.",
2774 bool, (rtx_insn *), NULL)
2776 /* True if X is considered to be commutative. */
2777 DEFHOOK
2778 (commutative_p,
2779 "This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.\n\
2780 Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider\n\
2781 PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code\n\
2782 of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.",
2783 bool, (const_rtx x, int outer_code),
2784 hook_bool_const_rtx_commutative_p)
2786 /* True if ADDR is an address-expression whose effect depends
2787 on the mode of the memory reference it is used in. */
2788 DEFHOOK
2789 (mode_dependent_address_p,
2790 "This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} in address\n\
2791 space @var{addrspace} can have\n\
2792 different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory\n\
2793 reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes\n\
2794 but not others.\n\
2796 Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent\n\
2797 effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size\n\
2798 of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent\n\
2799 addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.\n\
2801 You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.\n\
2803 The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.",
2804 bool, (const_rtx addr, addr_space_t addrspace),
2805 default_mode_dependent_address_p)
2807 /* Given an invalid address X for a given machine mode, try machine-specific
2808 ways to make it legitimate. Return X or an invalid address on failure. */
2809 DEFHOOK
2810 (legitimize_address,
2811 "This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an\n\
2812 operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory\n\
2813 address.\n\
2815 @findex break_out_memory_refs\n\
2816 @var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},\n\
2817 and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce\n\
2818 @var{x}.\n\
2820 The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of\n\
2821 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it\n\
2822 should return the new @var{x}.\n\
2824 It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address,\n\
2825 with the exception of native TLS addresses (@pxref{Emulated TLS}).\n\
2826 The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, if\n\
2827 the target supports only emulated TLS, it\n\
2828 is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find\n\
2829 a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent\n\
2830 strategy can generate better code.",
2831 rtx, (rtx x, rtx oldx, machine_mode mode),
2832 default_legitimize_address)
2834 /* Given an address RTX, undo the effects of LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS. */
2835 DEFHOOK
2836 (delegitimize_address,
2837 "This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the\n\
2838 @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target\n\
2839 macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol\n\
2840 references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar\n\
2841 addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand\n\
2842 the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back\n\
2843 into their original form.",
2844 rtx, (rtx x),
2845 delegitimize_mem_from_attrs)
2847 /* Given an RTX, return true if it is not ok to emit it into debug info
2848 section. */
2849 DEFHOOK
2850 (const_not_ok_for_debug_p,
2851 "This hook should return true if @var{x} should not be emitted into\n\
2852 debug sections.",
2853 bool, (rtx x),
2854 default_const_not_ok_for_debug_p)
2856 /* Given an address RTX, say whether it is valid. */
2857 DEFHOOK
2858 (legitimate_address_p,
2859 "A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory\n\
2860 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.\n\
2862 Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a\n\
2863 non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is\n\
2864 desired by the caller.\n\
2866 The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so\n\
2867 that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is\n\
2868 considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some\n\
2869 kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register\n\
2870 must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look\n\
2871 up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard\n\
2872 register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference\n\
2873 if the array holds @code{-1}.\n\
2875 The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to\n\
2876 accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of\n\
2877 register is required.\n\
2879 Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}\n\
2880 and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as\n\
2881 constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums\n\
2882 specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply\n\
2883 recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.\n\
2885 Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant\n\
2886 sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked\n\
2887 @code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such\n\
2888 naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will\n\
2889 be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.\n\
2891 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation\n\
2892 On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on\n\
2893 the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the\n\
2894 target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information\n\
2895 into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a\n\
2896 @code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the\n\
2897 @code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler\n\
2898 Format}.\n\
2900 @cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}\n\
2901 Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for\n\
2902 this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro\n\
2903 has this syntax:\n\
2905 @example\n\
2906 #define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})\n\
2907 @end example\n\
2909 @noindent\n\
2910 and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid\n\
2911 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.\n\
2913 @findex REG_OK_STRICT\n\
2914 Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this\n\
2915 macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an\n\
2916 @code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in\n\
2917 that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.\n\
2919 Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of\n\
2920 files that are recompiled when changes are made.",
2921 bool, (machine_mode mode, rtx x, bool strict),
2922 default_legitimate_address_p)
2924 /* True if the given constant can be put into an object_block. */
2925 DEFHOOK
2926 (use_blocks_for_constant_p,
2927 "This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can\n\
2928 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode\n\
2929 of @var{x}.\n\
2931 The default version returns false for all constants.",
2932 bool, (machine_mode mode, const_rtx x),
2933 hook_bool_mode_const_rtx_false)
2935 /* True if the given decl can be put into an object_block. */
2936 DEFHOOK
2937 (use_blocks_for_decl_p,
2938 "This hook should return true if pool entries for @var{decl} should\n\
2939 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure.\n\
2941 The default version returns true for all decls.",
2942 bool, (const_tree decl),
2943 hook_bool_const_tree_true)
2945 /* The minimum and maximum byte offsets for anchored addresses. */
2946 DEFHOOKPOD
2947 (min_anchor_offset,
2948 "The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.\n\
2949 On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be\n\
2950 applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address\n\
2951 for every mode. The default value is 0.",
2952 HOST_WIDE_INT, 0)
2954 DEFHOOKPOD
2955 (max_anchor_offset,
2956 "Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)\n\
2957 offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default\n\
2958 value is 0.",
2959 HOST_WIDE_INT, 0)
2961 /* True if section anchors can be used to access the given symbol. */
2962 DEFHOOK
2963 (use_anchors_for_symbol_p,
2964 "Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}\n\
2965 @var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and\n\
2966 @samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.\n\
2968 The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to\n\
2969 intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes\n\
2970 or target-specific sections.",
2971 bool, (const_rtx x),
2972 default_use_anchors_for_symbol_p)
2974 /* True if target supports indirect functions. */
2975 DEFHOOK
2976 (has_ifunc_p,
2977 "It returns true if the target supports GNU indirect functions.\n\
2978 The support includes the assembler, linker and dynamic linker.\n\
2979 The default value of this hook is based on target's libc.",
2980 bool, (void),
2981 default_has_ifunc_p)
2983 /* True if it is OK to do sibling call optimization for the specified
2984 call expression EXP. DECL will be the called function, or NULL if
2985 this is an indirect call. */
2986 DEFHOOK
2987 (function_ok_for_sibcall,
2988 "True if it is OK to do sibling call optimization for the specified\n\
2989 call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,\n\
2990 or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.\n\
2992 It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent\n\
2993 tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or\n\
2994 during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,\n\
2995 as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a\n\
2996 ``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization\n\
2997 may vary greatly between different architectures.",
2998 bool, (tree decl, tree exp),
2999 hook_bool_tree_tree_false)
3001 /* Establish appropriate back-end context for processing the function
3002 FNDECL. The argument might be NULL to indicate processing at top
3003 level, outside of any function scope. */
3004 DEFHOOK
3005 (set_current_function,
3006 "The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function\n\
3007 context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if\n\
3008 the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a\n\
3009 per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function\n\
3010 attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.\n\
3011 The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,\n\
3012 and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context\n\
3013 and is returning to processing at the top level.\n\
3014 The default hook function does nothing.\n\
3016 GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of\n\
3017 some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this\n\
3018 situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,\n\
3019 or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.\n\
3020 @code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,\n\
3021 outside of any function scope.",
3022 void, (tree decl), hook_void_tree)
3024 /* True if EXP should be placed in a "small data" section. */
3025 DEFHOOK
3026 (in_small_data_p,
3027 "Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.\n\
3028 The default version of this hook always returns false.",
3029 bool, (const_tree exp),
3030 hook_bool_const_tree_false)
3032 /* True if EXP names an object for which name resolution must resolve
3033 to the current executable or shared library. */
3034 DEFHOOK
3035 (binds_local_p,
3036 "Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution\n\
3037 rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library\n\
3038 or executable image).\n\
3040 The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules\n\
3041 for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other\n\
3042 currently supported object file formats.",
3043 bool, (const_tree exp),
3044 default_binds_local_p)
3046 /* Check if profiling code is before or after prologue. */
3047 DEFHOOK
3048 (profile_before_prologue,
3049 "It returns true if target wants profile code emitted before prologue.\n\n\
3050 The default version of this hook use the target macro\n\
3051 @code{PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE}.",
3052 bool, (void),
3053 default_profile_before_prologue)
3055 /* Return true if a leaf function should stay leaf even with profiling
3056 enabled. */
3057 DEFHOOK
3058 (keep_leaf_when_profiled,
3059 "This target hook returns true if the target wants the leaf flag for\
3060 the current function to stay true even if it calls mcount. This might\
3061 make sense for targets using the leaf flag only to determine whether a\
3062 stack frame needs to be generated or not and for which the call to\
3063 mcount is generated before the function prologue.",
3064 bool, (void),
3065 default_keep_leaf_when_profiled)
3067 /* Modify and return the identifier of a DECL's external name,
3068 originally identified by ID, as required by the target,
3069 (eg, append @nn to windows32 stdcall function names).
3070 The default is to return ID without modification. */
3071 DEFHOOK
3072 (mangle_decl_assembler_name,
3073 "Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated\n\
3074 by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be\n\
3075 the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,\n\
3076 or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the\n\
3077 hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on\n\
3078 your target system. The default implementation of this hook just\n\
3079 returns the @var{id} provided.",
3080 tree, (tree decl, tree id),
3081 default_mangle_decl_assembler_name)
3083 /* Do something target-specific to record properties of the DECL into
3084 the associated SYMBOL_REF. */
3085 DEFHOOK
3086 (encode_section_info,
3087 "Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be\n\
3088 treated differently depending on something about the variable or\n\
3089 function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).\n\
3091 The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for\n\
3092 @var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or\n\
3093 an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the\n\
3094 rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}\n\
3095 in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.\n\
3097 In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is\n\
3098 a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls\n\
3099 will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global\n\
3100 register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their\n\
3101 rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is\n\
3102 leave it alone.)\n\
3104 The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time\n\
3105 that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will\n\
3106 be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate\n\
3107 declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate\n\
3108 declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.\n\
3109 @var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.\n\
3111 @cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}\n\
3112 The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the\n\
3113 @code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.\n\
3114 Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to\n\
3115 encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now\n\
3116 discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.\n\
3118 The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}\n\
3119 in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in\n\
3120 @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need\n\
3121 before overriding it.",
3122 void, (tree decl, rtx rtl, int new_decl_p),
3123 default_encode_section_info)
3125 /* Undo the effects of encode_section_info on the symbol string. */
3126 DEFHOOK
3127 (strip_name_encoding,
3128 "Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans\n\
3129 the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}\n\
3130 may have added.",
3131 const char *, (const char *name),
3132 default_strip_name_encoding)
3134 /* If shift optabs for MODE are known to always truncate the shift count,
3135 return the mask that they apply. Return 0 otherwise. */
3136 DEFHOOK
3137 (shift_truncation_mask,
3138 "This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}\n\
3139 deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.\n\
3140 @xref{shift patterns}.\n\
3142 On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the\n\
3143 shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is\n\
3144 equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If\n\
3145 this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},\n\
3146 otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no\n\
3147 particular behavior is guaranteed.\n\
3149 Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does\n\
3150 @emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions\n\
3151 that are generated by the named shift patterns.\n\
3153 The default implementation of this function returns\n\
3154 @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}\n\
3155 and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if\n\
3156 @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns\n\
3157 nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code\n\
3158 by overriding it.",
3159 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, (machine_mode mode),
3160 default_shift_truncation_mask)
3162 /* Return the number of divisions in the given MODE that should be present,
3163 so that it is profitable to turn the division into a multiplication by
3164 the reciprocal. */
3165 DEFHOOK
3166 (min_divisions_for_recip_mul,
3167 "When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize\n\
3168 divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by\n\
3169 the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions\n\
3170 that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable\n\
3171 of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine\n\
3172 has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.",
3173 unsigned int, (machine_mode mode),
3174 default_min_divisions_for_recip_mul)
3176 DEFHOOK
3177 (truly_noop_truncation,
3178 "This hook returns true if it is safe to ``convert'' a value of\n\
3179 @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec} bits (where @var{outprec} is\n\
3180 smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely operating on it as if it had only\n\
3181 @var{outprec} bits. The default returns true unconditionally, which\n\
3182 is correct for most machines.\n\
3184 If @code{TARGET_MODES_TIEABLE_P} returns false for a pair of modes,\n\
3185 suboptimal code can result if this hook returns true for the corresponding\n\
3186 mode sizes. Making this hook return false in such cases may improve things.",
3187 bool, (poly_uint64 outprec, poly_uint64 inprec),
3188 hook_bool_puint64_puint64_true)
3190 /* If the representation of integral MODE is such that values are
3191 always sign-extended to a wider mode MODE_REP then return
3192 SIGN_EXTEND. Return UNKNOWN otherwise. */
3193 /* Note that the return type ought to be RTX_CODE, but that's not
3194 necessarily defined at this point. */
3195 DEFHOOK
3196 (mode_rep_extended,
3197 "The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values\n\
3198 are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return\n\
3199 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in\n\
3200 sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}\n\
3201 otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended\n\
3202 representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},\n\
3203 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either\n\
3204 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends\n\
3205 @var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next\n\
3206 widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)\n\
3208 Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}\n\
3209 value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers\n\
3210 as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers\n\
3211 @code{TARGET_CAN_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns false.\n\
3213 Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}\n\
3214 describe two related properties. If you define\n\
3215 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want\n\
3216 to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of\n\
3217 extension.\n\
3219 In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},\n\
3220 @code{TARGET_TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to\n\
3221 @code{mode}.",
3222 int, (scalar_int_mode mode, scalar_int_mode rep_mode),
3223 default_mode_rep_extended)
3225 /* True if MODE is valid for a pointer in __attribute__((mode("MODE"))). */
3226 DEFHOOK
3227 (valid_pointer_mode,
3228 "Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers\n\
3229 with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this\n\
3230 hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.",
3231 bool, (scalar_int_mode mode),
3232 default_valid_pointer_mode)
3234 /* Disambiguate with errno. */
3235 DEFHOOK
3236 (ref_may_alias_errno,
3237 "Define this to return nonzero if the memory reference @var{ref}\
3238 may alias with the system C library errno location. The default\
3239 version of this hook assumes the system C library errno location\
3240 is either a declaration of type int or accessed by dereferencing\
3241 a pointer to int.",
3242 bool, (struct ao_ref *ref),
3243 default_ref_may_alias_errno)
3245 /* Support for named address spaces. */
3246 #undef HOOK_PREFIX
3247 #define HOOK_PREFIX "TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_"
3248 HOOK_VECTOR (TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_HOOKS, addr_space)
3250 /* MODE to use for a pointer into another address space. */
3251 DEFHOOK
3252 (pointer_mode,
3253 "Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to\n\
3254 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.\n\
3255 The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode}.",
3256 scalar_int_mode, (addr_space_t address_space),
3257 default_addr_space_pointer_mode)
3259 /* MODE to use for an address in another address space. */
3260 DEFHOOK
3261 (address_mode,
3262 "Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in\n\
3263 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.\n\
3264 The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode}.",
3265 scalar_int_mode, (addr_space_t address_space),
3266 default_addr_space_address_mode)
3268 /* True if MODE is valid for a pointer in __attribute__((mode("MODE")))
3269 in another address space. */
3270 DEFHOOK
3271 (valid_pointer_mode,
3272 "Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers\n\
3273 with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target\n\
3274 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,\n\
3275 except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default\n\
3276 version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the\n\
3277 @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}\n\
3278 target hooks for the given address space.",
3279 bool, (scalar_int_mode mode, addr_space_t as),
3280 default_addr_space_valid_pointer_mode)
3282 /* True if an address is a valid memory address to a given named address
3283 space for a given mode. */
3284 DEFHOOK
3285 (legitimate_address_p,
3286 "Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode\n\
3287 @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}\n\
3288 parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has\n\
3289 finished. This target hook is the same as the\n\
3290 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes\n\
3291 explicit named address space support.",
3292 bool, (machine_mode mode, rtx exp, bool strict, addr_space_t as),
3293 default_addr_space_legitimate_address_p)
3295 /* Return an updated address to convert an invalid pointer to a named
3296 address space to a valid one. If NULL_RTX is returned use machine
3297 independent methods to make the address valid. */
3298 DEFHOOK
3299 (legitimize_address,
3300 "Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address\n\
3301 with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target\n\
3302 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,\n\
3303 except that it includes explicit named address space support.",
3304 rtx, (rtx x, rtx oldx, machine_mode mode, addr_space_t as),
3305 default_addr_space_legitimize_address)
3307 /* True if one named address space is a subset of another named address. */
3308 DEFHOOK
3309 (subset_p,
3310 "Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is\n\
3311 contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to\n\
3312 a named address space that is a subset of another named address space\n\
3313 will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in\n\
3314 arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be\n\
3315 converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.",
3316 bool, (addr_space_t subset, addr_space_t superset),
3317 default_addr_space_subset_p)
3319 /* True if 0 is a valid address in the address space, or false if
3320 0 is a NULL in the address space. */
3321 DEFHOOK
3322 (zero_address_valid,
3323 "Define this to modify the default handling of address 0 for the\n\
3324 address space. Return true if 0 should be considered a valid address.",
3325 bool, (addr_space_t as),
3326 default_addr_space_zero_address_valid)
3328 /* Function to convert an rtl expression from one address space to another. */
3329 DEFHOOK
3330 (convert,
3331 "Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL\n\
3332 @var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address\n\
3333 space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points\n\
3334 to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is\n\
3335 guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,\n\
3336 as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.",
3337 rtx, (rtx op, tree from_type, tree to_type),
3338 default_addr_space_convert)
3340 /* Function to encode an address space into dwarf. */
3341 DEFHOOK
3342 (debug,
3343 "Define this to define how the address space is encoded in dwarf.\n\
3344 The result is the value to be used with @code{DW_AT_address_class}.",
3345 int, (addr_space_t as),
3346 default_addr_space_debug)
3348 /* Function to emit custom diagnostic if an address space is used. */
3349 DEFHOOK
3350 (diagnose_usage,
3351 "Define this hook if the availability of an address space depends on\n\
3352 command line options and some diagnostics should be printed when the\n\
3353 address space is used. This hook is called during parsing and allows\n\
3354 to emit a better diagnostic compared to the case where the address space\n\
3355 was not registered with @code{c_register_addr_space}. @var{as} is\n\
3356 the address space as registered with @code{c_register_addr_space}.\n\
3357 @var{loc} is the location of the address space qualifier token.\n\
3358 The default implementation does nothing.",
3359 void, (addr_space_t as, location_t loc),
3360 default_addr_space_diagnose_usage)
3362 HOOK_VECTOR_END (addr_space)
3364 #undef HOOK_PREFIX
3365 #define HOOK_PREFIX "TARGET_"
3367 DEFHOOK
3368 (static_rtx_alignment,
3369 "This hook returns the preferred alignment in bits for a\n\
3370 statically-allocated rtx, such as a constant pool entry. @var{mode}\n\
3371 is the mode of the rtx. The default implementation returns\n\
3372 @samp{GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (@var{mode})}.",
3373 HOST_WIDE_INT, (machine_mode mode),
3374 default_static_rtx_alignment)
3376 DEFHOOK
3377 (constant_alignment,
3378 "This hook returns the alignment in bits of a constant that is being\n\
3379 placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and @var{basic_align}\n\
3380 is the alignment that the object would ordinarily have.\n\
3382 The default definition just returns @var{basic_align}.\n\
3384 The typical use of this hook is to increase alignment for string\n\
3385 constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy\n\
3386 constants can be done inline. The function\n\
3387 @code{constant_alignment_word_strings} provides such a definition.",
3388 HOST_WIDE_INT, (const_tree constant, HOST_WIDE_INT basic_align),
3389 default_constant_alignment)
3391 /* True if MODE is valid for the target. By "valid", we mean able to
3392 be manipulated in non-trivial ways. In particular, this means all
3393 the arithmetic is supported. */
3394 DEFHOOK
3395 (scalar_mode_supported_p,
3396 "Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle\n\
3397 insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be\n\
3398 considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons\n\
3399 must work.\n\
3401 The default version of this hook returns true for any mode\n\
3402 required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).\n\
3403 Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the\n\
3404 code in @file{optabs.c}.",
3405 bool, (scalar_mode mode),
3406 default_scalar_mode_supported_p)
3408 /* Similarly for vector modes. "Supported" here is less strict. At
3409 least some operations are supported; need to check optabs or builtins
3410 for further details. */
3411 DEFHOOK
3412 (vector_mode_supported_p,
3413 "Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle\n\
3414 insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it\n\
3415 must have move patterns for this mode.",
3416 bool, (machine_mode mode),
3417 hook_bool_mode_false)
3419 DEFHOOK
3420 (vector_alignment,
3421 "This hook can be used to define the alignment for a vector of type\n\
3422 @var{type}, in order to comply with a platform ABI. The default is to\n\
3423 require natural alignment for vector types. The alignment returned by\n\
3424 this hook must be a power-of-two multiple of the default alignment of\n\
3425 the vector element type.",
3426 HOST_WIDE_INT, (const_tree type),
3427 default_vector_alignment)
3429 /* True if we should try to use a scalar mode to represent an array,
3430 overriding the usual MAX_FIXED_MODE limit. */
3431 DEFHOOK
3432 (array_mode_supported_p,
3433 "Return true if GCC should try to use a scalar mode to store an array\n\
3434 of @var{nelems} elements, given that each element has mode @var{mode}.\n\
3435 Returning true here overrides the usual @code{MAX_FIXED_MODE} limit\n\
3436 and allows GCC to use any defined integer mode.\n\
3438 One use of this hook is to support vector load and store operations\n\
3439 that operate on several homogeneous vectors. For example, ARM NEON\n\
3440 has operations like:\n\
3442 @smallexample\n\
3443 int8x8x3_t vld3_s8 (const int8_t *)\n\
3444 @end smallexample\n\
3446 where the return type is defined as:\n\
3448 @smallexample\n\
3449 typedef struct int8x8x3_t\n\
3450 @{\n\
3451 int8x8_t val[3];\n\
3452 @} int8x8x3_t;\n\
3453 @end smallexample\n\
3455 If this hook allows @code{val} to have a scalar mode, then\n\
3456 @code{int8x8x3_t} can have the same mode. GCC can then store\n\
3457 @code{int8x8x3_t}s in registers rather than forcing them onto the stack.",
3458 bool, (machine_mode mode, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT nelems),
3459 hook_bool_mode_uhwi_false)
3461 DEFHOOK
3462 (libgcc_floating_mode_supported_p,
3463 "Define this to return nonzero if libgcc provides support for the \n\
3464 floating-point mode @var{mode}, which is known to pass \n\
3465 @code{TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P}. The default version of this \n\
3466 hook returns true for all of @code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode}, \n\
3467 @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode}, if such modes exist.",
3468 bool, (scalar_float_mode mode),
3469 default_libgcc_floating_mode_supported_p)
3471 DEFHOOK
3472 (floatn_mode,
3473 "Define this to return the machine mode to use for the type \n\
3474 @code{_Float@var{n}}, if @var{extended} is false, or the type \n\
3475 @code{_Float@var{n}x}, if @var{extended} is true. If such a type is not\n\
3476 supported, return @code{opt_scalar_float_mode ()}. The default version of\n\
3477 this hook returns @code{SFmode} for @code{_Float32}, @code{DFmode} for\n\
3478 @code{_Float64} and @code{_Float32x} and @code{TFmode} for \n\
3479 @code{_Float128}, if those modes exist and satisfy the requirements for \n\
3480 those types and pass @code{TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P} and \n\
3481 @code{TARGET_LIBGCC_FLOATING_MODE_SUPPORTED_P}; for @code{_Float64x}, it \n\
3482 returns the first of @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} that exists and \n\
3483 satisfies the same requirements; for other types, it returns \n\
3484 @code{opt_scalar_float_mode ()}. The hook is only called for values\n\
3485 of @var{n} and @var{extended} that are valid according to\n\
3486 ISO/IEC TS 18661-3:2015; that is, @var{n} is one of 32, 64, 128, or,\n\
3487 if @var{extended} is false, 16 or greater than 128 and a multiple of 32.",
3488 opt_scalar_float_mode, (int n, bool extended),
3489 default_floatn_mode)
3491 DEFHOOK
3492 (floatn_builtin_p,
3493 "Define this to return true if the @code{_Float@var{n}} and\n\
3494 @code{_Float@var{n}x} built-in functions should implicitly enable the\n\
3495 built-in function without the @code{__builtin_} prefix in addition to the\n\
3496 normal built-in function with the @code{__builtin_} prefix. The default is\n\
3497 to only enable built-in functions without the @code{__builtin_} prefix for\n\
3498 the GNU C langauge. In strict ANSI/ISO mode, the built-in function without\n\
3499 the @code{__builtin_} prefix is not enabled. The argument @code{FUNC} is the\n\
3500 @code{enum built_in_function} id of the function to be enabled.",
3501 bool, (int func),
3502 default_floatn_builtin_p)
3504 /* Compute cost of moving data from a register of class FROM to one of
3505 TO, using MODE. */
3506 DEFHOOK
3507 (register_move_cost,
3508 "This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}\n\
3509 from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes\n\
3510 are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.\n\
3511 A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to\n\
3512 that.\n\
3514 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the\n\
3515 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between\n\
3516 registers if they are not general registers.\n\
3518 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two\n\
3519 hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their\n\
3520 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the\n\
3521 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will\n\
3522 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this\n\
3523 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.\n\
3525 The default version of this function returns 2.",
3526 int, (machine_mode mode, reg_class_t from, reg_class_t to),
3527 default_register_move_cost)
3529 /* Compute cost of moving registers to/from memory. */
3530 /* ??? Documenting the argument types for this hook requires a GFDL
3531 license grant. Also, the documentation uses a different name for RCLASS. */
3532 DEFHOOK
3533 (memory_move_cost,
3534 "This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}\n\
3535 between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}\n\
3536 if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.\n\
3537 This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.\n\
3538 If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two\n\
3539 registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.\n\
3541 If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus\n\
3542 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is\n\
3543 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy\n\
3544 between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is\n\
3545 more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to\n\
3546 reflect the actual cost of the move.\n\
3548 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if\n\
3549 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via\n\
3550 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a\n\
3551 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of\n\
3552 4 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other\n\
3553 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function\n\
3554 are the same as to this target hook.",
3555 int, (machine_mode mode, reg_class_t rclass, bool in),
3556 default_memory_move_cost)
3558 DEFHOOK
3559 (use_by_pieces_infrastructure_p,
3560 "GCC will attempt several strategies when asked to copy between\n\
3561 two areas of memory, or to set, clear or store to memory, for example\n\
3562 when copying a @code{struct}. The @code{by_pieces} infrastructure\n\
3563 implements such memory operations as a sequence of load, store or move\n\
3564 insns. Alternate strategies are to expand the\n\
3565 @code{movmem} or @code{setmem} optabs, to emit a library call, or to emit\n\
3566 unit-by-unit, loop-based operations.\n\
3568 This target hook should return true if, for a memory operation with a\n\
3569 given @var{size} and @var{alignment}, using the @code{by_pieces}\n\
3570 infrastructure is expected to result in better code generation.\n\
3571 Both @var{size} and @var{alignment} are measured in terms of storage\n\
3572 units.\n\
3574 The parameter @var{op} is one of: @code{CLEAR_BY_PIECES},\n\
3575 @code{MOVE_BY_PIECES}, @code{SET_BY_PIECES}, @code{STORE_BY_PIECES} or\n\
3576 @code{COMPARE_BY_PIECES}. These describe the type of memory operation\n\
3577 under consideration.\n\
3579 The parameter @var{speed_p} is true if the code is currently being\n\
3580 optimized for speed rather than size.\n\
3582 Returning true for higher values of @var{size} can improve code generation\n\
3583 for speed if the target does not provide an implementation of the\n\
3584 @code{movmem} or @code{setmem} standard names, if the @code{movmem} or\n\
3585 @code{setmem} implementation would be more expensive than a sequence of\n\
3586 insns, or if the overhead of a library call would dominate that of\n\
3587 the body of the memory operation.\n\
3589 Returning true for higher values of @code{size} may also cause an increase\n\
3590 in code size, for example where the number of insns emitted to perform a\n\
3591 move would be greater than that of a library call.",
3592 bool, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT size, unsigned int alignment,
3593 enum by_pieces_operation op, bool speed_p),
3594 default_use_by_pieces_infrastructure_p)
3596 DEFHOOK
3597 (compare_by_pieces_branch_ratio,
3598 "When expanding a block comparison in MODE, gcc can try to reduce the\n\
3599 number of branches at the expense of more memory operations. This hook\n\
3600 allows the target to override the default choice. It should return the\n\
3601 factor by which branches should be reduced over the plain expansion with\n\
3602 one comparison per @var{mode}-sized piece. A port can also prevent a\n\
3603 particular mode from being used for block comparisons by returning a\n\
3604 negative number from this hook.",
3605 int, (machine_mode mode),
3606 default_compare_by_pieces_branch_ratio)
3608 DEFHOOK
3609 (slow_unaligned_access,
3610 "This hook returns true if memory accesses described by the\n\
3611 @var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater\n\
3612 than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap handler.\n\
3613 This hook is invoked only for unaligned accesses, i.e. when\n\
3614 @code{@var{alignment} < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (@var{mode})}.\n\
3616 When this hook returns true, the compiler will act as if\n\
3617 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were true when generating code for block\n\
3618 moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.\n\
3619 Therefore, do not make this hook return true if unaligned accesses only\n\
3620 add a cycle or two to the time for a memory access.\n\
3622 The hook must return true whenever @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is true.\n\
3623 The default implementation returns @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT}.",
3624 bool, (machine_mode mode, unsigned int align),
3625 default_slow_unaligned_access)
3627 DEFHOOK
3628 (optab_supported_p,
3629 "Return true if the optimizers should use optab @var{op} with\n\
3630 modes @var{mode1} and @var{mode2} for optimization type @var{opt_type}.\n\
3631 The optab is known to have an associated @file{.md} instruction\n\
3632 whose C condition is true. @var{mode2} is only meaningful for conversion\n\
3633 optabs; for direct optabs it is a copy of @var{mode1}.\n\
3635 For example, when called with @var{op} equal to @code{rint_optab} and\n\
3636 @var{mode1} equal to @code{DFmode}, the hook should say whether the\n\
3637 optimizers should use optab @code{rintdf2}.\n\
3639 The default hook returns true for all inputs.",
3640 bool, (int op, machine_mode mode1, machine_mode mode2,
3641 optimization_type opt_type),
3642 default_optab_supported_p)
3644 /* True for MODE if the target expects that registers in this mode will
3645 be allocated to registers in a small register class. The compiler is
3646 allowed to use registers explicitly used in the rtl as spill registers
3647 but it should prevent extending the lifetime of these registers. */
3648 DEFHOOK
3649 (small_register_classes_for_mode_p,
3650 "Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has\n\
3651 small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given\n\
3652 @var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers\n\
3653 in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.\n\
3654 In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero\n\
3655 for any mode.\n\
3657 On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary\n\
3658 insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values\n\
3659 to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail\n\
3660 if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an\n\
3661 insn.\n\
3663 Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used\n\
3664 in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in\n\
3665 the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register\n\
3666 classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point\n\
3667 registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific\n\
3668 registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many\n\
3669 SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good\n\
3670 strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}\n\
3671 machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.\n\
3673 The default version of this hook returns false for any mode. It is always\n\
3674 safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you\n\
3675 unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations\n\
3676 that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook\n\
3677 to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out\n\
3678 of spill registers and print a fatal error message.",
3679 bool, (machine_mode mode),
3680 hook_bool_mode_false)
3682 /* Register number for a flags register. Only needs to be defined if the
3683 target is constrainted to use post-reload comparison elimination. */
3684 DEFHOOKPOD
3685 (flags_regnum,
3686 "If the target has a dedicated flags register, and it needs to use the\
3687 post-reload comparison elimination pass, then this value should be set\
3688 appropriately.",
3689 unsigned int, INVALID_REGNUM)
3691 /* Compute a (partial) cost for rtx X. Return true if the complete
3692 cost has been computed, and false if subexpressions should be
3693 scanned. In either case, *TOTAL contains the cost result. */
3694 /* Note that OUTER_CODE ought to be RTX_CODE, but that's
3695 not necessarily defined at this point. */
3696 DEFHOOK
3697 (rtx_costs,
3698 "This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.\n\
3700 The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is\n\
3701 available for examination in @var{x}, and the fact that @var{x} appears\n\
3702 as operand @var{opno} of an expression with rtx code @var{outer_code}.\n\
3703 That is, the hook can assume that there is some rtx @var{y} such\n\
3704 that @samp{GET_CODE (@var{y}) == @var{outer_code}} and such that\n\
3705 either (a) @samp{XEXP (@var{y}, @var{opno}) == @var{x}} or\n\
3706 (b) @samp{XVEC (@var{y}, @var{opno})} contains @var{x}.\n\
3708 @var{mode} is @var{x}'s machine mode, or for cases like @code{const_int} that\n\
3709 do not have a mode, the mode in which @var{x} is used.\n\
3711 In implementing this hook, you can use the construct\n\
3712 @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast\n\
3713 instructions.\n\
3715 On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate\n\
3716 for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as\n\
3717 necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}\n\
3718 for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus\n\
3719 operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.\n\
3721 When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is\n\
3722 false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative\n\
3723 size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.\n\
3725 The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been\n\
3726 processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.",
3727 bool, (rtx x, machine_mode mode, int outer_code, int opno, int *total, bool speed),
3728 hook_bool_rtx_mode_int_int_intp_bool_false)
3730 /* Compute the cost of X, used as an address. Never called with
3731 invalid addresses. */
3732 DEFHOOK
3733 (address_cost,
3734 "This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains\n\
3735 @var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from\n\
3736 the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.\n\
3738 For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the\n\
3739 true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all\n\
3740 instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence\n\
3741 all addresses will have equal costs.\n\
3743 In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with\n\
3744 the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,\n\
3745 cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.\n\
3747 For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register\n\
3748 and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro\n\
3749 is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory\n\
3750 references will be indirect through that register. On machines where\n\
3751 the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than\n\
3752 that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional\n\
3753 instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper\n\
3754 specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.\n\
3756 This hook is never called with an invalid address.\n\
3758 On machines where an address involving more than one register is as\n\
3759 cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining\n\
3760 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to\n\
3761 be live over a region of code where only one would have been if\n\
3762 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect\n\
3763 should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs\n\
3764 should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of\n\
3765 registers on machines with lots of registers.",
3766 int, (rtx address, machine_mode mode, addr_space_t as, bool speed),
3767 default_address_cost)
3769 /* Compute a cost for INSN. */
3770 DEFHOOK
3771 (insn_cost,
3772 "This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL instructions.\n\
3774 In implementing this hook, you can use the construct\n\
3775 @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast\n\
3776 instructions.\n\
3778 When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is\n\
3779 false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative\n\
3780 size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.",
3781 int, (rtx_insn *insn, bool speed), NULL)
3783 /* Give a cost, in RTX Costs units, for an edge. Like BRANCH_COST, but with
3784 well defined units. */
3785 DEFHOOK
3786 (max_noce_ifcvt_seq_cost,
3787 "This hook returns a value in the same units as @code{TARGET_RTX_COSTS},\n\
3788 giving the maximum acceptable cost for a sequence generated by the RTL\n\
3789 if-conversion pass when conditional execution is not available.\n\
3790 The RTL if-conversion pass attempts to convert conditional operations\n\
3791 that would require a branch to a series of unconditional operations and\n\
3792 @code{mov@var{mode}cc} insns. This hook returns the maximum cost of the\n\
3793 unconditional instructions and the @code{mov@var{mode}cc} insns.\n\
3794 RTL if-conversion is cancelled if the cost of the converted sequence\n\
3795 is greater than the value returned by this hook.\n\
3797 @code{e} is the edge between the basic block containing the conditional\n\
3798 branch to the basic block which would be executed if the condition\n\
3799 were true.\n\
3801 The default implementation of this hook uses the\n\
3802 @code{max-rtl-if-conversion-[un]predictable} parameters if they are set,\n\
3803 and uses a multiple of @code{BRANCH_COST} otherwise.",
3804 unsigned int, (edge e),
3805 default_max_noce_ifcvt_seq_cost)
3807 /* Return true if the given instruction sequence is a good candidate
3808 as a replacement for the if-convertible sequence. */
3809 DEFHOOK
3810 (noce_conversion_profitable_p,
3811 "This hook returns true if the instruction sequence @code{seq} is a good\n\
3812 candidate as a replacement for the if-convertible sequence described in\n\
3813 @code{if_info}.",
3814 bool, (rtx_insn *seq, struct noce_if_info *if_info),
3815 default_noce_conversion_profitable_p)
3817 DEFHOOK
3818 (estimated_poly_value,
3819 "Return an estimate of the runtime value of @var{val}, for use in\n\
3820 things like cost calculations or profiling frequencies. The default\n\
3821 implementation returns the lowest possible value of @var{val}.",
3822 HOST_WIDE_INT, (poly_int64 val),
3823 default_estimated_poly_value)
3825 /* Permit speculative instructions in delay slots during delayed-branch
3826 scheduling. */
3827 DEFHOOK
3828 (no_speculation_in_delay_slots_p,
3829 "This predicate controls the use of the eager delay slot filler to disallow\n\
3830 speculatively executed instructions being placed in delay slots. Targets\n\
3831 such as certain MIPS architectures possess both branches with and without\n\
3832 delay slots. As the eager delay slot filler can decrease performance,\n\
3833 disabling it is beneficial when ordinary branches are available. Use of\n\
3834 delay slot branches filled using the basic filler is often still desirable\n\
3835 as the delay slot can hide a pipeline bubble.", bool, (void),
3836 hook_bool_void_false)
3838 /* Return where to allocate pseudo for a given hard register initial value. */
3839 DEFHOOK
3840 (allocate_initial_value,
3841 "\n\
3842 When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo\n\
3843 register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register\n\
3844 to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot\n\
3845 it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}\n\
3846 is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register\n\
3847 that had its initial value copied by using\n\
3848 @code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.\n\
3849 Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want\n\
3850 to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be\n\
3851 the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a\n\
3852 @code{MEM}.\n\
3853 If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;\n\
3854 it might decide to use another register anyways.\n\
3855 You may use @code{current_function_is_leaf} or \n\
3856 @code{REG_N_SETS} in the hook to determine if the hard\n\
3857 register in question will not be clobbered.\n\
3858 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special\n\
3859 allocation.",
3860 rtx, (rtx hard_reg), NULL)
3862 /* Return nonzero if evaluating UNSPEC X might cause a trap.
3863 FLAGS has the same meaning as in rtlanal.c: may_trap_p_1. */
3864 DEFHOOK
3865 (unspec_may_trap_p,
3866 "This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or\n\
3867 @code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use\n\
3868 this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and\n\
3869 @code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}\n\
3870 to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be\n\
3871 passed along.",
3872 int, (const_rtx x, unsigned flags),
3873 default_unspec_may_trap_p)
3875 /* Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers
3876 to represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook
3877 if the register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in
3878 non-contiguous locations, or if the register should be
3879 represented in more than one register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this
3880 hook should return NULL_RTX. */
3881 DEFHOOK
3882 (dwarf_register_span,
3883 "Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to\n\
3884 represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the\n\
3885 register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous\n\
3886 locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one\n\
3887 register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.\n\
3888 If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.",
3889 rtx, (rtx reg),
3890 hook_rtx_rtx_null)
3892 /* Given a register return the mode of the corresponding DWARF frame
3893 register. */
3894 DEFHOOK
3895 (dwarf_frame_reg_mode,
3896 "Given a register, this hook should return the mode which the\n\
3897 corresponding Dwarf frame register should have. This is normally\n\
3898 used to return a smaller mode than the raw mode to prevent call\n\
3899 clobbered parts of a register altering the frame register size",
3900 machine_mode, (int regno),
3901 default_dwarf_frame_reg_mode)
3903 /* If expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes needs to fill in table
3904 entries not corresponding directly to registers below
3905 FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, this hook should generate the necessary
3906 code, given the address of the table. */
3907 DEFHOOK
3908 (init_dwarf_reg_sizes_extra,
3909 "If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in\n\
3910 multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the\n\
3911 sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.\n\
3912 It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after\n\
3913 filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;\n\
3914 @var{address} is the address of the table.",
3915 void, (tree address),
3916 hook_void_tree)
3918 /* Fetch the fixed register(s) which hold condition codes, for
3919 targets where it makes sense to look for duplicate assignments to
3920 the condition codes. This should return true if there is such a
3921 register, false otherwise. The arguments should be set to the
3922 fixed register numbers. Up to two condition code registers are
3923 supported. If there is only one for this target, the int pointed
3924 at by the second argument should be set to -1. */
3925 DEFHOOK
3926 (fixed_condition_code_regs,
3927 "On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard\n\
3928 register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the\n\
3929 regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the\n\
3930 hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a\n\
3931 small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true\n\
3932 to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its\n\
3933 arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.\n\
3934 When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the\n\
3935 integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to\n\
3936 @code{INVALID_REGNUM}.\n\
3938 The default version of this hook returns false.",
3939 bool, (unsigned int *p1, unsigned int *p2),
3940 hook_bool_uintp_uintp_false)
3942 /* If two condition code modes are compatible, return a condition
3943 code mode which is compatible with both, such that a comparison
3944 done in the returned mode will work for both of the original
3945 modes. If the condition code modes are not compatible, return
3946 VOIDmode. */
3947 DEFHOOK
3948 (cc_modes_compatible,
3949 "On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class\n\
3950 @code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be\n\
3951 validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this\n\
3952 target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which\n\
3953 both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,\n\
3954 return @code{VOIDmode}.\n\
3956 The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the\n\
3957 same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it\n\
3958 returns @code{VOIDmode}.",
3959 machine_mode, (machine_mode m1, machine_mode m2),
3960 default_cc_modes_compatible)
3962 /* Do machine-dependent code transformations. Called just before
3963 delayed-branch scheduling. */
3964 DEFHOOK
3965 (machine_dependent_reorg,
3966 "If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the\n\
3967 instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,\n\
3968 just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.\n\
3970 The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use\n\
3971 it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as\n\
3972 laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.\n\
3973 Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.\n\
3975 You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default\n\
3976 definition is null.",
3977 void, (void), NULL)
3979 /* Create the __builtin_va_list type. */
3980 DEFHOOK
3981 (build_builtin_va_list,
3982 "This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.\n\
3983 The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.",
3984 tree, (void),
3985 std_build_builtin_va_list)
3987 /* Enumerate the va list variants. */
3988 DEFHOOK
3989 (enum_va_list_p,
3990 "This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}\n\
3991 to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The\n\
3992 variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer\n\
3993 to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed\n\
3994 variable.\n\
3995 The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of\n\
3996 this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its\n\
3997 internal type.\n\
3998 If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.\n\
3999 Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this\n\
4000 macro to iterate through all types.",
4001 int, (int idx, const char **pname, tree *ptree),
4002 NULL)
4004 /* Get the cfun/fndecl calling abi __builtin_va_list type. */
4005 DEFHOOK
4006 (fn_abi_va_list,
4007 "This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by\n\
4008 @var{fndecl}.\n\
4009 The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.",
4010 tree, (tree fndecl),
4011 std_fn_abi_va_list)
4013 /* Get the __builtin_va_list type dependent on input type. */
4014 DEFHOOK
4015 (canonical_va_list_type,
4016 "This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the\n\
4017 type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns\n\
4018 @code{NULL_TREE}.",
4019 tree, (tree type),
4020 std_canonical_va_list_type)
4022 /* ??? Documenting this hook requires a GFDL license grant. */
4023 DEFHOOK_UNDOC
4024 (expand_builtin_va_start,
4025 "Expand the @code{__builtin_va_start} builtin.",
4026 void, (tree valist, rtx nextarg), NULL)
4028 /* Gimplifies a VA_ARG_EXPR. */
4029 DEFHOOK
4030 (gimplify_va_arg_expr,
4031 "This hook performs target-specific gimplification of\n\
4032 @code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the\n\
4033 arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in\n\
4034 @code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.",
4035 tree, (tree valist, tree type, gimple_seq *pre_p, gimple_seq *post_p),
4036 std_gimplify_va_arg_expr)
4038 /* Validity-checking routines for PCH files, target-specific.
4039 get_pch_validity returns a pointer to the data to be stored,
4040 and stores the size in its argument. pch_valid_p gets the same
4041 information back and returns NULL if the PCH is valid,
4042 or an error message if not. */
4043 DEFHOOK
4044 (get_pch_validity,
4045 "This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by\n\
4046 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets\n\
4047 @samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.",
4048 void *, (size_t *sz),
4049 default_get_pch_validity)
4051 DEFHOOK
4052 (pch_valid_p,
4053 "This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are\n\
4054 compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}\n\
4055 if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will\n\
4056 be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.\n\
4058 @var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}\n\
4059 when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.\n\
4060 It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the\n\
4061 compiler, so no format checking is needed.\n\
4063 The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be\n\
4064 suitable for most targets.",
4065 const char *, (const void *data, size_t sz),
4066 default_pch_valid_p)
4068 DEFHOOK
4069 (prepare_pch_save,
4070 "Called before writing out a PCH file. If the target has some\n\
4071 garbage-collected data that needs to be in a particular state on PCH loads,\n\
4072 it can use this hook to enforce that state. Very few targets need\n\
4073 to do anything here.",
4074 void, (void),
4075 hook_void_void)
4077 /* If nonnull, this function checks whether a PCH file with the
4078 given set of target flags can be used. It returns NULL if so,
4079 otherwise it returns an error message. */
4080 DEFHOOK
4081 (check_pch_target_flags,
4082 "If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of\n\
4083 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values\n\
4084 of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that\n\
4085 @code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return\n\
4086 value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.",
4087 const char *, (int pch_flags), NULL)
4089 /* True if the compiler should give an enum type only as many
4090 bytes as it takes to represent the range of possible values of
4091 that type. */
4092 DEFHOOK
4093 (default_short_enums,
4094 "This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an\n\
4095 @code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range\n\
4096 of possible values of that type. It should return false if all\n\
4097 @code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.\n\
4099 The default is to return false.",
4100 bool, (void),
4101 hook_bool_void_false)
4103 /* This target hook returns an rtx that is used to store the address
4104 of the current frame into the built-in setjmp buffer. */
4105 DEFHOOK
4106 (builtin_setjmp_frame_value,
4107 "This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store\n\
4108 the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.\n\
4109 The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most\n\
4110 machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if\n\
4111 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.",
4112 rtx, (void),
4113 default_builtin_setjmp_frame_value)
4115 /* This target hook should manipulate the outputs, inputs, constraints,
4116 and clobbers the port wishes for pre-processing the asm. */
4117 DEFHOOK
4118 (md_asm_adjust,
4119 "This target hook may add @dfn{clobbers} to @var{clobbers} and\n\
4120 @var{clobbered_regs} for any hard regs the port wishes to automatically\n\
4121 clobber for an asm. The @var{outputs} and @var{inputs} may be inspected\n\
4122 to avoid clobbering a register that is already used by the asm.\n\
4124 It may modify the @var{outputs}, @var{inputs}, and @var{constraints}\n\
4125 as necessary for other pre-processing. In this case the return value is\n\
4126 a sequence of insns to emit after the asm.",
4127 rtx_insn *,
4128 (vec<rtx>& outputs, vec<rtx>& inputs, vec<const char *>& constraints,
4129 vec<rtx>& clobbers, HARD_REG_SET& clobbered_regs),
4130 NULL)
4132 /* This target hook allows the backend to specify a calling convention
4133 in the debug information. This function actually returns an
4134 enum dwarf_calling_convention, but because of forward declarations
4135 and not wanting to include dwarf2.h everywhere target.h is included
4136 the function is being declared as an int. */
4137 DEFHOOK
4138 (dwarf_calling_convention,
4139 "Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to\n\
4140 be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum\n\
4141 value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.",
4142 int, (const_tree function),
4143 hook_int_const_tree_0)
4145 /* This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
4146 contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The call frame debugging info
4147 engine will invoke it on insns of the form
4148 (set (reg) (unspec [...] UNSPEC_INDEX))
4150 (set (reg) (unspec_volatile [...] UNSPECV_INDEX))
4151 to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. */
4152 DEFHOOK
4153 (dwarf_handle_frame_unspec,
4154 "This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that\n\
4155 contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging\n\
4156 info engine will invoke it on insns of the form\n\
4157 @smallexample\n\
4158 (set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))\n\
4159 @end smallexample\n\
4160 and\n\
4161 @smallexample\n\
4162 (set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).\n\
4163 @end smallexample\n\
4164 to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is\n\
4165 the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of\n\
4166 the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.",
4167 void, (const char *label, rtx pattern, int index), NULL)
4169 DEFHOOK
4170 (dwarf_poly_indeterminate_value,
4171 "Express the value of @code{poly_int} indeterminate @var{i} as a DWARF\n\
4172 expression, with @var{i} counting from 1. Return the number of a DWARF\n\
4173 register @var{R} and set @samp{*@var{factor}} and @samp{*@var{offset}} such\n\
4174 that the value of the indeterminate is:\n\
4175 @smallexample\n\
4176 value_of(@var{R}) / @var{factor} - @var{offset}\n\
4177 @end smallexample\n\
4179 A target only needs to define this hook if it sets\n\
4180 @samp{NUM_POLY_INT_COEFFS} to a value greater than 1.",
4181 unsigned int, (unsigned int i, unsigned int *factor, int *offset),
4182 default_dwarf_poly_indeterminate_value)
4184 /* ??? Documenting this hook requires a GFDL license grant. */
4185 DEFHOOK_UNDOC
4186 (stdarg_optimize_hook,
4187 "Perform architecture specific checking of statements gimplified\
4188 from @code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. @var{stmt} is the statement. Returns true if\
4189 the statement doesn't need to be checked for @code{va_list} references.",
4190 bool, (struct stdarg_info *ai, const gimple *stmt), NULL)
4192 /* This target hook allows the operating system to override the DECL
4193 that represents the external variable that contains the stack
4194 protection guard variable. The type of this DECL is ptr_type_node. */
4195 DEFHOOK
4196 (stack_protect_guard,
4197 "This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use\n\
4198 for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the\n\
4199 runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value\n\
4200 that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this\n\
4201 variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.\n\
4203 The default version of this hook creates a variable called\n\
4204 @samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.",
4205 tree, (void),
4206 default_stack_protect_guard)
4208 /* This target hook allows the operating system to override the CALL_EXPR
4209 that is invoked when a check vs the guard variable fails. */
4210 DEFHOOK
4211 (stack_protect_fail,
4212 "This hook returns a @code{CALL_EXPR} that alerts the runtime that the\n\
4213 stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should\n\
4214 involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.\n\
4216 The default version of this hook invokes a function called\n\
4217 @samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is\n\
4218 normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.",
4219 tree, (void),
4220 default_external_stack_protect_fail)
4222 /* This target hook allows the operating system to disable the default stack
4223 protector runtime support. */
4224 DEFHOOK
4225 (stack_protect_runtime_enabled_p,
4226 "Returns true if the target wants GCC's default stack protect runtime support,\
4227 otherwise return false. The default implementation always returns true.",
4228 bool, (void),
4229 hook_bool_void_true)
4231 DEFHOOK
4232 (can_use_doloop_p,
4233 "Return true if it is possible to use low-overhead loops (@code{doloop_end}\n\
4234 and @code{doloop_begin}) for a particular loop. @var{iterations} gives the\n\
4235 exact number of iterations, or 0 if not known. @var{iterations_max} gives\n\
4236 the maximum number of iterations, or 0 if not known. @var{loop_depth} is\n\
4237 the nesting depth of the loop, with 1 for innermost loops, 2 for loops that\n\
4238 contain innermost loops, and so on. @var{entered_at_top} is true if the\n\
4239 loop is only entered from the top.\n\
4241 This hook is only used if @code{doloop_end} is available. The default\n\
4242 implementation returns true. You can use @code{can_use_doloop_if_innermost}\n\
4243 if the loop must be the innermost, and if there are no other restrictions.",
4244 bool, (const widest_int &iterations, const widest_int &iterations_max,
4245 unsigned int loop_depth, bool entered_at_top),
4246 hook_bool_wint_wint_uint_bool_true)
4248 /* Returns NULL if target supports the insn within a doloop block,
4249 otherwise it returns an error message. */
4250 DEFHOOK
4251 (invalid_within_doloop,
4252 "\n\
4253 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a\n\
4254 low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop\n\
4255 could not be applied.\n\
4257 Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any\n\
4258 instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating\n\
4259 the reason why the doloop could not be applied.\n\
4260 By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for\n\
4261 loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.",
4262 const char *, (const rtx_insn *insn),
4263 default_invalid_within_doloop)
4265 /* Returns true for a legitimate combined insn. */
4266 DEFHOOK
4267 (legitimate_combined_insn,
4268 "Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return @code{false} if the instruction\
4269 is not appropriate as a combination of two or more instructions. The\
4270 default is to accept all instructions.",
4271 bool, (rtx_insn *insn),
4272 hook_bool_rtx_insn_true)
4274 DEFHOOK
4275 (valid_dllimport_attribute_p,
4276 "@var{decl} is a variable or function with @code{__attribute__((dllimport))}\
4277 specified. Use this hook if the target needs to add extra validation\
4278 checks to @code{handle_dll_attribute}.",
4279 bool, (const_tree decl),
4280 hook_bool_const_tree_true)
4282 /* If non-zero, align constant anchors in CSE to a multiple of this
4283 value. */
4284 DEFHOOKPOD
4285 (const_anchor,
4286 "On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize\n\
4287 a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that\n\
4288 is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant\n\
4289 is computed from this register using immediate addition or\n\
4290 subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of\n\
4291 the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the\n\
4292 available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new\n\
4293 constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and\n\
4294 down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.\n\
4295 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value\n\
4296 accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the\n\
4297 value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on\n\
4298 MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,\n\
4299 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value\n\
4300 is zero, which disables this optimization.",
4301 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, 0)
4303 /* Defines, which target-dependent bits (upper 16) are used by port */
4304 DEFHOOK
4305 (memmodel_check,
4306 "Validate target specific memory model mask bits. When NULL no target specific\n\
4307 memory model bits are allowed.",
4308 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT val), NULL)
4310 /* Defines an offset bitwise ored into shifted address to get corresponding
4311 Address Sanitizer shadow address, or -1 if Address Sanitizer is not
4312 supported by the target. */
4313 DEFHOOK
4314 (asan_shadow_offset,
4315 "Return the offset bitwise ored into shifted address to get corresponding\n\
4316 Address Sanitizer shadow memory address. NULL if Address Sanitizer is not\n\
4317 supported by the target.",
4318 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, (void),
4319 NULL)
4321 /* Functions relating to calls - argument passing, returns, etc. */
4322 /* Members of struct call have no special macro prefix. */
4323 HOOK_VECTOR (TARGET_CALLS, calls)
4325 DEFHOOK
4326 (promote_function_mode,
4327 "Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or\n\
4328 function return values. The target hook should return the new mode\n\
4329 and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should\n\
4330 change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or\n\
4331 pointer} types.\n\
4333 @var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and\n\
4334 return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and\n\
4335 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.\n\
4336 If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in\n\
4337 which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;\n\
4338 then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though\n\
4339 the signedness may be different.\n\
4341 @var{type} can be NULL when promoting function arguments of libcalls.\n\
4343 The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can\n\
4344 also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}\n\
4345 if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.",
4346 machine_mode, (const_tree type, machine_mode mode, int *punsignedp,
4347 const_tree funtype, int for_return),
4348 default_promote_function_mode)
4350 DEFHOOK
4351 (promote_prototypes,
4352 "This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a\n\
4353 prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be\n\
4354 passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain\n\
4355 cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.\n\
4356 The default is to not promote prototypes.",
4357 bool, (const_tree fntype),
4358 hook_bool_const_tree_false)
4360 DEFHOOK
4361 (struct_value_rtx,
4362 "This target hook should return the location of the structure value\n\
4363 address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is\n\
4364 passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may\n\
4365 be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target\n\
4366 hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first\n\
4367 argument.\n\
4369 On some architectures the place where the structure value address\n\
4370 is found by the called function is not the same place that the\n\
4371 caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could\n\
4372 be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.\n\
4373 @var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in\n\
4374 the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of\n\
4375 the caller.\n\
4377 If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the\n\
4378 stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If\n\
4379 @var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the\n\
4380 structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need\n\
4381 to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.",
4382 rtx, (tree fndecl, int incoming),
4383 hook_rtx_tree_int_null)
4385 DEFHOOKPOD
4386 (omit_struct_return_reg,
4387 "Normally, when a function returns a structure by memory, the address\n\
4388 is passed as an invisible pointer argument, but the compiler also\n\
4389 arranges to return the address from the function like it would a normal\n\
4390 pointer return value. Define this to true if that behavior is\n\
4391 undesirable on your target.",
4392 bool, false)
4394 DEFHOOK
4395 (return_in_memory,
4396 "This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the\n\
4397 function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.\n\
4398 Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}\n\
4399 will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for\n\
4400 libcalls.\n\
4402 Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled\n\
4403 by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}\n\
4404 takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is\n\
4405 possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default\n\
4406 definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}\n\
4407 values, and 0 otherwise.\n\
4409 Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always\n\
4410 be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}\n\
4411 to indicate this.",
4412 bool, (const_tree type, const_tree fntype),
4413 default_return_in_memory)
4415 DEFHOOK
4416 (return_in_msb,
4417 "This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned\n\
4418 at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are\n\
4419 padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}\n\
4420 is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.\n\
4422 Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must\n\
4423 be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-\n\
4424 or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a\n\
4425 4-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an\n\
4426 @code{SImode} rtx.",
4427 bool, (const_tree type),
4428 hook_bool_const_tree_false)
4430 /* Return true if a parameter must be passed by reference. TYPE may
4431 be null if this is a libcall. CA may be null if this query is
4432 from __builtin_va_arg. */
4433 DEFHOOK
4434 (pass_by_reference,
4435 "This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the\n\
4436 position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This\n\
4437 predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being\n\
4438 passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.\n\
4440 If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a\n\
4441 pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.\n\
4442 The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer\n\
4443 to that type.",
4444 bool,
4445 (cumulative_args_t cum, machine_mode mode, const_tree type, bool named),
4446 hook_bool_CUMULATIVE_ARGS_mode_tree_bool_false)
4448 DEFHOOK
4449 (expand_builtin_saveregs,
4450 "If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to\n\
4451 @code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very\n\
4452 beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The\n\
4453 return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value\n\
4454 to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.",
4455 rtx, (void),
4456 default_expand_builtin_saveregs)
4458 /* Returns pretend_argument_size. */
4459 DEFHOOK
4460 (setup_incoming_varargs,
4461 "This target hook offers an alternative to using\n\
4462 @code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook\n\
4463 @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous\n\
4464 register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to\n\
4465 have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can\n\
4466 use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that\n\
4467 pass all their arguments on the stack.\n\
4469 The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data\n\
4470 structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the\n\
4471 named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the\n\
4472 last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.\n\
4474 The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the\n\
4475 argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,\n\
4476 store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued\n\
4477 variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you\n\
4478 store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack\n\
4479 frame.\n\
4481 Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at\n\
4482 compile time without knowing their data types,\n\
4483 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that\n\
4484 have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly\n\
4485 for all data types.\n\
4487 If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the\n\
4488 arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This\n\
4489 happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the\n\
4490 end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should\n\
4491 not generate any instructions in this case.",
4492 void, (cumulative_args_t args_so_far, machine_mode mode, tree type,
4493 int *pretend_args_size, int second_time),
4494 default_setup_incoming_varargs)
4496 DEFHOOK
4497 (load_bounds_for_arg,
4498 "This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to load bounds of\n\
4499 @var{arg} passed in @var{slot}. Expand pass uses this hook in case\n\
4500 bounds of @var{arg} are not passed in register. If @var{slot} is a\n\
4501 memory, then bounds are loaded as for regular pointer loaded from\n\
4502 memory. If @var{slot} is not a memory then @var{slot_no} is an integer\n\
4503 constant holding number of the target dependent special slot which\n\
4504 should be used to obtain bounds. Hook returns RTX holding loaded bounds.",
4505 rtx, (rtx slot, rtx arg, rtx slot_no),
4506 default_load_bounds_for_arg)
4508 DEFHOOK
4509 (store_bounds_for_arg,
4510 "This hook is used by expand pass to emit insns to store @var{bounds} of\n\
4511 @var{arg} passed in @var{slot}. Expand pass uses this hook in case\n\
4512 @var{bounds} of @var{arg} are not passed in register. If @var{slot} is a\n\
4513 memory, then @var{bounds} are stored as for regular pointer stored in\n\
4514 memory. If @var{slot} is not a memory then @var{slot_no} is an integer\n\
4515 constant holding number of the target dependent special slot which\n\
4516 should be used to store @var{bounds}.",
4517 void, (rtx arg, rtx slot, rtx bounds, rtx slot_no),
4518 default_store_bounds_for_arg)
4520 DEFHOOK
4521 (load_returned_bounds,
4522 "This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to load bounds\n\
4523 returned by function call in @var{slot}. Hook returns RTX holding\n\
4524 loaded bounds.",
4525 rtx, (rtx slot),
4526 default_load_returned_bounds)
4528 DEFHOOK
4529 (store_returned_bounds,
4530 "This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to store @var{bounds}\n\
4531 returned by function call into @var{slot}.",
4532 void, (rtx slot, rtx bounds),
4533 default_store_returned_bounds)
4535 DEFHOOK
4536 (setup_incoming_vararg_bounds,
4537 "Use it to store bounds for anonymous register arguments stored\n\
4538 into the stack. Arguments meaning is similar to\n\
4539 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}.",
4540 void, (cumulative_args_t args_so_far, machine_mode mode, tree type,
4541 int *pretend_args_size, int second_time),
4542 default_setup_incoming_vararg_bounds)
4544 DEFHOOK
4545 (call_args,
4546 "While generating RTL for a function call, this target hook is invoked once\n\
4547 for each argument passed to the function, either a register returned by\n\
4548 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} or a memory location. It is called just\n\
4549 before the point where argument registers are stored. The type of the\n\
4550 function to be called is also passed as the second argument; it is\n\
4551 @code{NULL_TREE} for libcalls. The @code{TARGET_END_CALL_ARGS} hook is\n\
4552 invoked just after the code to copy the return reg has been emitted.\n\
4553 This functionality can be used to perform special setup of call argument\n\
4554 registers if a target needs it.\n\
4555 For functions without arguments, the hook is called once with @code{pc_rtx}\n\
4556 passed instead of an argument register.\n\
4557 Most ports do not need to implement anything for this hook.",
4558 void, (rtx, tree),
4559 hook_void_rtx_tree)
4561 DEFHOOK
4562 (end_call_args,
4563 "This target hook is invoked while generating RTL for a function call,\n\
4564 just after the point where the return reg is copied into a pseudo. It\n\
4565 signals that all the call argument and return registers for the just\n\
4566 emitted call are now no longer in use.\n\
4567 Most ports do not need to implement anything for this hook.",
4568 void, (void),
4569 hook_void_void)
4571 DEFHOOK
4572 (strict_argument_naming,
4573 "Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function\n\
4574 argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.\n\
4576 This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}\n\
4577 is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns\n\
4578 @code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named\n\
4579 arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},\n\
4580 but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},\n\
4581 then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments\n\
4582 except the last are treated as named.\n\
4584 You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.",
4585 bool, (cumulative_args_t ca),
4586 hook_bool_CUMULATIVE_ARGS_false)
4588 /* Returns true if we should use
4589 targetm.calls.setup_incoming_varargs() and/or
4590 targetm.calls.strict_argument_naming(). */
4591 DEFHOOK
4592 (pretend_outgoing_varargs_named,
4593 "If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with\n\
4594 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither\n\
4595 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was\n\
4596 defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if\n\
4597 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.\n\
4598 Otherwise, you should not define this hook.",
4599 bool, (cumulative_args_t ca),
4600 default_pretend_outgoing_varargs_named)
4602 /* Given a complex type T, return true if a parameter of type T
4603 should be passed as two scalars. */
4604 DEFHOOK
4605 (split_complex_arg,
4606 "This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed\n\
4607 as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex\n\
4608 arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments\n\
4609 to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on\n\
4610 AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point\n\
4611 registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating\n\
4612 point register.\n\
4614 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always\n\
4615 false.",
4616 bool, (const_tree type), NULL)
4618 /* Return true if type T, mode MODE, may not be passed in registers,
4619 but must be passed on the stack. */
4620 /* ??? This predicate should be applied strictly after pass-by-reference.
4621 Need audit to verify that this is the case. */
4622 DEFHOOK
4623 (must_pass_in_stack,
4624 "This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}\n\
4625 solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a\n\
4626 definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional\n\
4627 documentation.",
4628 bool, (machine_mode mode, const_tree type),
4629 must_pass_in_stack_var_size_or_pad)
4631 /* Return true if type TYPE, mode MODE, which is passed by reference,
4632 should have the object copy generated by the callee rather than
4633 the caller. It is never called for TYPE requiring constructors. */
4634 DEFHOOK
4635 (callee_copies,
4636 "The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is\n\
4637 known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the\n\
4638 function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied\n\
4639 by the caller.\n\
4641 For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be\n\
4642 determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need\n\
4643 not be generated.\n\
4645 The default version of this hook always returns false.",
4646 bool,
4647 (cumulative_args_t cum, machine_mode mode, const_tree type, bool named),
4648 hook_bool_CUMULATIVE_ARGS_mode_tree_bool_false)
4650 /* Return zero for arguments passed entirely on the stack or entirely
4651 in registers. If passed in both, return the number of bytes passed
4652 in registers; the balance is therefore passed on the stack. */
4653 DEFHOOK
4654 (arg_partial_bytes,
4655 "This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an\n\
4656 argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for\n\
4657 arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely\n\
4658 pushed on the stack.\n\
4660 On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in\n\
4661 registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the\n\
4662 first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest\n\
4663 on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a\n\
4664 structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed\n\
4665 in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the\n\
4666 compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.\n\
4668 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first\n\
4669 register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise\n\
4670 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.",
4671 int, (cumulative_args_t cum, machine_mode mode, tree type, bool named),
4672 hook_int_CUMULATIVE_ARGS_mode_tree_bool_0)
4674 /* Update the state in CA to advance past an argument in the
4675 argument list. The values MODE, TYPE, and NAMED describe that
4676 argument. */
4677 DEFHOOK
4678 (function_arg_advance,
4679 "This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to\n\
4680 advance past an argument in the argument list. The values @var{mode},\n\
4681 @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument. Once this is done,\n\
4682 the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following}\n\
4683 argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.\n\
4685 This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed\n\
4686 on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space\n\
4687 used for arguments without any special help.",
4688 void,
4689 (cumulative_args_t ca, machine_mode mode, const_tree type, bool named),
4690 default_function_arg_advance)
4692 DEFHOOK
4693 (function_arg_offset,
4694 "This hook returns the number of bytes to add to the offset of an\n\
4695 argument of type @var{type} and mode @var{mode} when passed in memory.\n\
4696 This is needed for the SPU, which passes @code{char} and @code{short}\n\
4697 arguments in the preferred slot that is in the middle of the quad word\n\
4698 instead of starting at the top. The default implementation returns 0.",
4699 HOST_WIDE_INT, (machine_mode mode, const_tree type),
4700 default_function_arg_offset)
4702 DEFHOOK
4703 (function_arg_padding,
4704 "This hook determines whether, and in which direction, to pad out\n\
4705 an argument of mode @var{mode} and type @var{type}. It returns\n\
4706 @code{PAD_UPWARD} to insert padding above the argument, @code{PAD_DOWNWARD}\n\
4707 to insert padding below the argument, or @code{PAD_NONE} to inhibit padding.\n\
4709 The @emph{amount} of padding is not controlled by this hook, but by\n\
4710 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY}. It is always just enough\n\
4711 to reach the next multiple of that boundary.\n\
4713 This hook has a default definition that is right for most systems.\n\
4714 For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For\n\
4715 big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of\n\
4716 constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.",
4717 pad_direction, (machine_mode mode, const_tree type),
4718 default_function_arg_padding)
4720 /* Return zero if the argument described by the state of CA should
4721 be placed on a stack, or a hard register in which to store the
4722 argument. The values MODE, TYPE, and NAMED describe that
4723 argument. */
4724 DEFHOOK
4725 (function_arg,
4726 "Return an RTX indicating whether a function argument is passed in a\n\
4727 register and if so, which register.\n\
4729 The arguments are @var{ca}, which summarizes all the previous\n\
4730 arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},\n\
4731 the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known\n\
4732 (which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},\n\
4733 which is @code{true} for an ordinary argument and @code{false} for\n\
4734 nameless arguments that correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called\n\
4735 function's prototype. @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a\n\
4736 syntax error has previously occurred.\n\
4738 The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard\n\
4739 register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument\n\
4740 on the stack.\n\
4742 The return value can be a @code{const_int} which means argument is\n\
4743 passed in a target specific slot with specified number. Target hooks\n\
4744 should be used to store or load argument in such case. See\n\
4745 @code{TARGET_STORE_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG} and @code{TARGET_LOAD_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG}\n\
4746 for more information.\n\
4748 The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is\n\
4749 used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the\n\
4750 @code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The\n\
4751 @code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one\n\
4752 describes where part of the argument is passed. In each\n\
4753 @code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard\n\
4754 register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the\n\
4755 register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The\n\
4756 second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives\n\
4757 the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.\n\
4758 As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}\n\
4759 RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire\n\
4760 argument is also stored on the stack.\n\
4762 The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==\n\
4763 VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}\n\
4764 pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.\n\
4766 @cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments\n\
4767 The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a\n\
4768 machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to\n\
4769 cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is\n\
4770 done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever\n\
4771 @var{named} is @code{false}.\n\
4773 @cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}\n\
4774 @cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}\n\
4775 You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}\n\
4776 in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a\n\
4777 type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}\n\
4778 is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an\n\
4779 argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is\n\
4780 defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into\n\
4781 a register.",
4782 rtx, (cumulative_args_t ca, machine_mode mode, const_tree type,
4783 bool named),
4784 default_function_arg)
4786 DEFHOOK
4787 (function_incoming_arg,
4788 "Define this hook if the caller and callee on the target have different\n\
4789 views of where arguments are passed. Also define this hook if there are\n\
4790 functions that are never directly called, but are invoked by the hardware\n\
4791 and which have nonstandard calling conventions.\n\
4793 In this case @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in\n\
4794 which the caller passes the value, and\n\
4795 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar\n\
4796 fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will\n\
4797 arrive.\n\
4799 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} can also return arbitrary address\n\
4800 computation using hard register, which can be forced into a register,\n\
4801 so that it can be used to pass special arguments.\n\
4803 If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined,\n\
4804 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes.",
4805 rtx, (cumulative_args_t ca, machine_mode mode, const_tree type,
4806 bool named),
4807 default_function_incoming_arg)
4809 DEFHOOK
4810 (function_arg_boundary,
4811 "This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument\n\
4812 with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns\n\
4813 @code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.",
4814 unsigned int, (machine_mode mode, const_tree type),
4815 default_function_arg_boundary)
4817 DEFHOOK
4818 (function_arg_round_boundary,
4819 "Normally, the size of an argument is rounded up to @code{PARM_BOUNDARY},\n\
4820 which is the default value for this hook. You can define this hook to\n\
4821 return a different value if an argument size must be rounded to a larger\n\
4822 value.",
4823 unsigned int, (machine_mode mode, const_tree type),
4824 default_function_arg_round_boundary)
4826 /* Return the diagnostic message string if function without a prototype
4827 is not allowed for this 'val' argument; NULL otherwise. */
4828 DEFHOOK
4829 (invalid_arg_for_unprototyped_fn,
4830 "If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is\n\
4831 illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}\n\
4832 with prototype @var{typelist}.",
4833 const char *, (const_tree typelist, const_tree funcdecl, const_tree val),
4834 hook_invalid_arg_for_unprototyped_fn)
4836 /* Return an rtx for the return value location of the function
4837 specified by FN_DECL_OR_TYPE with a return type of RET_TYPE. */
4838 DEFHOOK
4839 (function_value,
4840 "\n\
4841 Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function\n\
4842 returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node\n\
4843 representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node\n\
4844 representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a\n\
4845 function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should\n\
4846 compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.\n\
4847 Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where\n\
4848 a function returns a value.\n\
4850 On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.\n\
4851 (Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same\n\
4852 place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a\n\
4853 @code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.\n\
4854 The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in\n\
4855 multiple places. See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the\n\
4856 @code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every\n\
4857 location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of\n\
4858 the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use\n\
4859 that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k\n\
4860 port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both\n\
4861 @samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.\n\
4863 If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply\n\
4864 the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if\n\
4865 @var{valtype} is a scalar type.\n\
4867 If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree\n\
4868 node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null\n\
4869 pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning\n\
4870 convention for specific functions when all their calls are\n\
4871 known.\n\
4873 Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in\n\
4874 which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which\n\
4875 the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return\n\
4876 different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.\n\
4878 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with\n\
4879 aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See\n\
4880 @code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.",
4881 rtx, (const_tree ret_type, const_tree fn_decl_or_type, bool outgoing),
4882 default_function_value)
4884 /* Return the rtx for bounds of returned pointer. */
4885 DEFHOOK
4886 (chkp_function_value_bounds,
4887 "Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function\n\
4888 returns bounds for returned pointers. Arguments meaning is similar to\n\
4889 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE}.",
4890 rtx, (const_tree ret_type, const_tree fn_decl_or_type, bool outgoing),
4891 default_chkp_function_value_bounds)
4893 /* Return the rtx for the result of a libcall of mode MODE,
4894 calling the function FN_NAME. */
4895 DEFHOOK
4896 (libcall_value,
4897 "Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall\n\
4898 function in order to determine where the result should be returned.\n\
4900 The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called\n\
4901 library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX\n\
4902 representing the place where the library function result will be returned.\n\
4904 If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.",
4905 rtx, (machine_mode mode, const_rtx fun),
4906 default_libcall_value)
4908 /* Return true if REGNO is a possible register number for
4909 a function value as seen by the caller. */
4910 DEFHOOK
4911 (function_value_regno_p,
4912 "A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard\n\
4913 register in which the values of called function may come back.\n\
4915 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the\n\
4916 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be\n\
4917 recognized by this target hook.\n\
4919 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called\n\
4920 function use different registers for the return value, this target hook\n\
4921 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.\n\
4923 If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.",
4924 bool, (const unsigned int regno),
4925 default_function_value_regno_p)
4927 /* ??? Documenting this hook requires a GFDL license grant. */
4928 DEFHOOK_UNDOC
4929 (internal_arg_pointer,
4930 "Return an rtx for the argument pointer incoming to the\
4931 current function.",
4932 rtx, (void),
4933 default_internal_arg_pointer)
4935 /* Update the current function stack boundary if needed. */
4936 DEFHOOK
4937 (update_stack_boundary,
4938 "Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if\n\
4939 necessary.",
4940 void, (void), NULL)
4942 /* Handle stack alignment and return an rtx for Dynamic Realign
4943 Argument Pointer if necessary. */
4944 DEFHOOK
4945 (get_drap_rtx,
4946 "This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a\n\
4947 different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's\n\
4948 argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP\n\
4949 is needed.",
4950 rtx, (void), NULL)
4952 /* Return true if all function parameters should be spilled to the
4953 stack. */
4954 DEFHOOK
4955 (allocate_stack_slots_for_args,
4956 "When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not\n\
4957 arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates\n\
4958 stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make\n\
4959 debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with\n\
4960 @code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler\n\
4961 cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed\n\
4962 to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but\n\
4963 false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.",
4964 bool, (void),
4965 hook_bool_void_true)
4967 /* Return an rtx for the static chain for FNDECL_OR_TYPE. If INCOMING_P
4968 is true, then it should be for the callee; otherwise for the caller. */
4969 DEFHOOK
4970 (static_chain,
4971 "This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for\n\
4972 targets that may use different static chain locations for different\n\
4973 nested functions. This may be required if the target has function\n\
4974 attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and\n\
4975 those calling conventions use different static chain locations.\n\
4977 The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.\n\
4979 If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to\n\
4980 provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.\n\
4981 Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset\n\
4982 from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee\n\
4983 will be at an offset from the frame pointer.\n\
4984 @findex stack_pointer_rtx\n\
4985 @findex frame_pointer_rtx\n\
4986 @findex arg_pointer_rtx\n\
4987 The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and\n\
4988 @code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used\n\
4989 to refer to those items.",
4990 rtx, (const_tree fndecl_or_type, bool incoming_p),
4991 default_static_chain)
4993 /* Fill in the trampoline at MEM with a call to FNDECL and a
4994 static chain value of CHAIN. */
4995 DEFHOOK
4996 (trampoline_init,
4997 "This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.\n\
4998 @var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}\n\
4999 is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an\n\
5000 RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function\n\
5001 when it is called.\n\
5003 If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the\n\
5004 first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}\n\
5005 from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.\n\
5006 Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the\n\
5007 trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline\n\
5008 to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.\n\
5010 If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or\n\
5011 enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after\n\
5012 initializing the trampoline proper.",
5013 void, (rtx m_tramp, tree fndecl, rtx static_chain),
5014 default_trampoline_init)
5016 /* Adjust the address of the trampoline in a target-specific way. */
5017 DEFHOOK
5018 (trampoline_adjust_address,
5019 "This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in\n\
5020 the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the\n\
5021 memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case\n\
5022 the address to be used for a function call should be different from the\n\
5023 address at which the template was stored, the different address should\n\
5024 be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.\n\
5025 If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.",
5026 rtx, (rtx addr), NULL)
5028 DEFHOOKPOD
5029 (custom_function_descriptors,
5030 "This hook should be defined to a power of 2 if the target will benefit\n\
5031 from the use of custom descriptors for nested functions instead of the\n\
5032 standard trampolines. Such descriptors are created at run time on the\n\
5033 stack and made up of data only, but they are non-standard so the generated\n\
5034 code must be prepared to deal with them. This hook should be defined to 0\n\
5035 if the target uses function descriptors for its standard calling sequence,\n\
5036 like for example HP-PA or IA-64. Using descriptors for nested functions\n\
5037 eliminates the need for trampolines that reside on the stack and require\n\
5038 it to be made executable.\n\
5040 The value of the macro is used to parameterize the run-time identification\n\
5041 scheme implemented to distinguish descriptors from function addresses: it\n\
5042 gives the number of bytes by which their address is misaligned compared\n\
5043 with function addresses. The value of 1 will generally work, unless it is\n\
5044 already reserved by the target for another purpose, like for example on ARM.",\
5045 int, -1)
5047 /* Return the number of bytes of its own arguments that a function
5048 pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments and the
5049 caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns. */
5050 /* ??? tm.texi has no types for the parameters. */
5051 DEFHOOK
5052 (return_pops_args,
5053 "This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that\n\
5054 a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments\n\
5055 and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.\n\
5057 @var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes\n\
5058 the function in question. Normally it is a node of type\n\
5059 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.\n\
5060 From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.\n\
5062 @var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that\n\
5063 describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type\n\
5064 @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.\n\
5065 From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and\n\
5066 arguments (if known).\n\
5068 When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}\n\
5069 will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if\n\
5070 you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so\n\
5071 by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means\n\
5072 a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially\n\
5073 in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.\n\
5075 @var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the\n\
5076 stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and\n\
5077 argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.\n\
5079 On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition\n\
5080 of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard\n\
5081 calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of\n\
5082 the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling\n\
5083 convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of\n\
5084 arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop\n\
5085 nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,\n\
5086 @var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed\n\
5087 number of arguments.",
5088 poly_int64, (tree fundecl, tree funtype, poly_int64 size),
5089 default_return_pops_args)
5091 /* Return a mode wide enough to copy any function value that might be
5092 returned. */
5093 DEFHOOK
5094 (get_raw_result_mode,
5095 "This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw return\
5096 registers in @code{__builtin_return}. Define this macro if the value\
5097 in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.",
5098 fixed_size_mode, (int regno),
5099 default_get_reg_raw_mode)
5101 /* Return a mode wide enough to copy any argument value that might be
5102 passed. */
5103 DEFHOOK
5104 (get_raw_arg_mode,
5105 "This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw argument\
5106 registers in @code{__builtin_apply_args}. Define this macro if the value\
5107 in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.",
5108 fixed_size_mode, (int regno),
5109 default_get_reg_raw_mode)
5111 /* Return true if a type is an empty record. */
5112 DEFHOOK
5113 (empty_record_p,
5114 "This target hook returns true if the type is an empty record. The default\n\
5115 is to return @code{false}.",
5116 bool, (const_tree type),
5117 hook_bool_const_tree_false)
5119 /* Warn about the change in empty class parameter passing ABI. */
5120 DEFHOOK
5121 (warn_parameter_passing_abi,
5122 "This target hook warns about the change in empty class parameter passing\n\
5123 ABI.",
5124 void, (cumulative_args_t ca, tree type),
5125 hook_void_CUMULATIVE_ARGS_tree)
5127 HOOK_VECTOR_END (calls)
5129 DEFHOOK
5130 (use_pseudo_pic_reg,
5131 "This hook should return 1 in case pseudo register should be created\n\
5132 for pic_offset_table_rtx during function expand.",
5133 bool, (void),
5134 hook_bool_void_false)
5136 DEFHOOK
5137 (init_pic_reg,
5138 "Perform a target dependent initialization of pic_offset_table_rtx.\n\
5139 This hook is called at the start of register allocation.",
5140 void, (void),
5141 hook_void_void)
5143 /* Return the diagnostic message string if conversion from FROMTYPE
5144 to TOTYPE is not allowed, NULL otherwise. */
5145 DEFHOOK
5146 (invalid_conversion,
5147 "If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is\n\
5148 invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}\n\
5149 if validity should be determined by the front end.",
5150 const char *, (const_tree fromtype, const_tree totype),
5151 hook_constcharptr_const_tree_const_tree_null)
5153 /* Return the diagnostic message string if the unary operation OP is
5154 not permitted on TYPE, NULL otherwise. */
5155 DEFHOOK
5156 (invalid_unary_op,
5157 "If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is\n\
5158 invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by\n\
5159 @code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}\n\
5160 if validity should be determined by the front end.",
5161 const char *, (int op, const_tree type),
5162 hook_constcharptr_int_const_tree_null)
5164 /* Return the diagnostic message string if the binary operation OP
5165 is not permitted on TYPE1 and TYPE2, NULL otherwise. */
5166 DEFHOOK
5167 (invalid_binary_op,
5168 "If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is\n\
5169 invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}\n\
5170 and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by\n\
5171 the front end.",
5172 const char *, (int op, const_tree type1, const_tree type2),
5173 hook_constcharptr_int_const_tree_const_tree_null)
5175 /* If values of TYPE are promoted to some other type when used in
5176 expressions (analogous to the integer promotions), return that type,
5177 or NULL_TREE otherwise. */
5178 DEFHOOK
5179 (promoted_type,
5180 "If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of\n\
5181 @var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,\n\
5182 analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the\n\
5183 front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are\n\
5184 target-specific types with special promotion rules.\n\
5185 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.",
5186 tree, (const_tree type),
5187 hook_tree_const_tree_null)
5189 /* Convert EXPR to TYPE, if target-specific types with special conversion
5190 rules are involved. Return the converted expression, or NULL to apply
5191 the standard conversion rules. */
5192 DEFHOOK
5193 (convert_to_type,
5194 "If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to\n\
5195 @var{type}. It should return the converted expression,\n\
5196 or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.\n\
5197 This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special\n\
5198 conversion rules.\n\
5199 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.",
5200 tree, (tree type, tree expr),
5201 hook_tree_tree_tree_null)
5203 DEFHOOK
5204 (can_change_mode_class,
5205 "This hook returns true if it is possible to bitcast values held in\n\
5206 registers of class @var{rclass} from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to}\n\
5207 and if doing so preserves the low-order bits that are common to both modes.\n\
5208 The result is only meaningful if @var{rclass} has registers that can hold\n\
5209 both @code{from} and @code{to}. The default implementation returns true.\n\
5211 As an example of when such bitcasting is invalid, loading 32-bit integer or\n\
5212 floating-point objects into floating-point registers on Alpha extends them\n\
5213 to 64 bits. Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a\n\
5214 32-bit object does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case\n\
5215 for a normal register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines\n\
5216 @code{TARGET_CAN_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} to return:\n\
5218 @smallexample\n\
5219 (GET_MODE_SIZE (from) == GET_MODE_SIZE (to)\n\
5220 || !reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, rclass))\n\
5221 @end smallexample\n\
5223 Even if storing from a register in mode @var{to} would be valid,\n\
5224 if both @var{from} and @code{raw_reg_mode} for @var{rclass} are wider\n\
5225 than @code{word_mode}, then we must prevent @var{to} narrowing the\n\
5226 mode. This happens when the middle-end assumes that it can load\n\
5227 or store pieces of an @var{N}-word pseudo, and that the pseudo will\n\
5228 eventually be allocated to @var{N} @code{word_mode} hard registers.\n\
5229 Failure to prevent this kind of mode change will result in the\n\
5230 entire @code{raw_reg_mode} being modified instead of the partial\n\
5231 value that the middle-end intended.",
5232 bool, (machine_mode from, machine_mode to, reg_class_t rclass),
5233 hook_bool_mode_mode_reg_class_t_true)
5235 /* Change pseudo allocno class calculated by IRA. */
5236 DEFHOOK
5237 (ira_change_pseudo_allocno_class,
5238 "A target hook which can change allocno class for given pseudo from\n\
5239 allocno and best class calculated by IRA.\n\
5241 The default version of this target hook always returns given class.",
5242 reg_class_t, (int, reg_class_t, reg_class_t),
5243 default_ira_change_pseudo_allocno_class)
5245 /* Return true if we use LRA instead of reload. */
5246 DEFHOOK
5247 (lra_p,
5248 "A target hook which returns true if we use LRA instead of reload pass.\
5250 The default version of this target hook returns true. New ports\
5251 should use LRA, and existing ports are encouraged to convert.",
5252 bool, (void),
5253 default_lra_p)
5255 /* Return register priority of given hard regno for the current target. */
5256 DEFHOOK
5257 (register_priority,
5258 "A target hook which returns the register priority number to which the\
5259 register @var{hard_regno} belongs to. The bigger the number, the\
5260 more preferable the hard register usage (when all other conditions are\
5261 the same). This hook can be used to prefer some hard register over\
5262 others in LRA. For example, some x86-64 register usage needs\
5263 additional prefix which makes instructions longer. The hook can\
5264 return lower priority number for such registers make them less favorable\
5265 and as result making the generated code smaller.\
5267 The default version of this target hook returns always zero.",
5268 int, (int),
5269 default_register_priority)
5271 /* Return true if we need register usage leveling. */
5272 DEFHOOK
5273 (register_usage_leveling_p,
5274 "A target hook which returns true if we need register usage leveling.\
5275 That means if a few hard registers are equally good for the\
5276 assignment, we choose the least used hard register. The register\
5277 usage leveling may be profitable for some targets. Don't use the\
5278 usage leveling for targets with conditional execution or targets\
5279 with big register files as it hurts if-conversion and cross-jumping\
5280 optimizations.\
5282 The default version of this target hook returns always false.",
5283 bool, (void),
5284 default_register_usage_leveling_p)
5286 /* Return true if maximal address displacement can be different. */
5287 DEFHOOK
5288 (different_addr_displacement_p,
5289 "A target hook which returns true if an address with the same structure\
5290 can have different maximal legitimate displacement. For example, the\
5291 displacement can depend on memory mode or on operand combinations in\
5292 the insn.\
5294 The default version of this target hook returns always false.",
5295 bool, (void),
5296 default_different_addr_displacement_p)
5298 /* Determine class for spilling pseudos of given mode into registers
5299 instead of memory. */
5300 DEFHOOK
5301 (spill_class,
5302 "This hook defines a class of registers which could be used for spilling\
5303 pseudos of the given mode and class, or @code{NO_REGS} if only memory\
5304 should be used. Not defining this hook is equivalent to returning\
5305 @code{NO_REGS} for all inputs.",
5306 reg_class_t, (reg_class_t, machine_mode),
5307 NULL)
5309 /* Determine an additional allocno class. */
5310 DEFHOOK
5311 (additional_allocno_class_p,
5312 "This hook should return @code{true} if given class of registers should\
5313 be an allocno class in any way. Usually RA uses only one register\
5314 class from all classes containing the same register set. In some\
5315 complicated cases, you need to have two or more such classes as\
5316 allocno ones for RA correct work. Not defining this hook is\
5317 equivalent to returning @code{false} for all inputs.",
5318 bool, (reg_class_t),
5319 hook_bool_reg_class_t_false)
5321 DEFHOOK
5322 (cstore_mode,
5323 "This hook defines the machine mode to use for the boolean result of\
5324 conditional store patterns. The ICODE argument is the instruction code\
5325 for the cstore being performed. Not definiting this hook is the same\
5326 as accepting the mode encoded into operand 0 of the cstore expander\
5327 patterns.",
5328 scalar_int_mode, (enum insn_code icode),
5329 default_cstore_mode)
5331 /* This target hook allows the backend to compute the register pressure
5332 classes to use. */
5333 DEFHOOK
5334 (compute_pressure_classes,
5335 "A target hook which lets a backend compute the set of pressure classes to\
5336 be used by those optimization passes which take register pressure into\
5337 account, as opposed to letting IRA compute them. It returns the number of\
5338 register classes stored in the array @var{pressure_classes}.",
5339 int, (enum reg_class *pressure_classes), NULL)
5341 /* True if a structure, union or array with MODE containing FIELD should
5342 be accessed using BLKmode. */
5343 DEFHOOK
5344 (member_type_forces_blk,
5345 "Return true if a structure, union or array containing @var{field} should\n\
5346 be accessed using @code{BLKMODE}.\n\
5348 If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its\n\
5349 mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the\n\
5350 case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to\n\
5351 retain the field's mode.\n\
5353 Normally, this is not needed.",
5354 bool, (const_tree field, machine_mode mode),
5355 default_member_type_forces_blk)
5357 /* See tree-ssa-math-opts.c:divmod_candidate_p for conditions
5358 that gate the divod transform. */
5359 DEFHOOK
5360 (expand_divmod_libfunc,
5361 "Define this hook for enabling divmod transform if the port does not have\n\
5362 hardware divmod insn but defines target-specific divmod libfuncs.",
5363 void, (rtx libfunc, machine_mode mode, rtx op0, rtx op1, rtx *quot, rtx *rem),
5364 NULL)
5366 /* Return the class for a secondary reload, and fill in extra information. */
5367 DEFHOOK
5368 (secondary_reload,
5369 "Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or\n\
5370 from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the\n\
5371 @samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or\n\
5372 from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the\n\
5373 term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed\n\
5374 directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate\n\
5375 register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the\n\
5376 destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as\n\
5377 source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,\n\
5378 reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register\n\
5379 and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the\n\
5380 intermediate register still holds the required value.\n\
5382 Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which\n\
5383 allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch\n\
5384 register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic\n\
5385 address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC\n\
5386 when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode\n\
5387 as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than\n\
5388 that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to\n\
5389 describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;\n\
5390 these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)\n\
5391 of the scratch register(s).\n\
5393 In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.\n\
5395 For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},\n\
5396 and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class\n\
5397 @var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target\n\
5398 hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}\n\
5399 needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.\n\
5401 If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires\n\
5402 an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should\n\
5403 return the register class required for this intermediate register.\n\
5404 If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.\n\
5405 If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one\n\
5406 that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.\n\
5408 If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to\n\
5409 perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this\n\
5410 closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is\n\
5411 required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the\n\
5412 copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.\n\
5414 You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern\n\
5415 in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output\n\
5416 and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are\n\
5417 for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a\n\
5418 single-register-class\n\
5419 @c [later: or memory]\n\
5420 output constraint.\n\
5422 When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}\n\
5423 hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate\n\
5424 register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also\n\
5425 have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.\n\
5427 @c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -\n\
5428 @c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -\n\
5429 @c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required\n\
5430 @c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match\n\
5431 @c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class\n\
5432 @c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an\n\
5433 @c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.\n\
5434 @c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]\n\
5437 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a\n\
5438 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.\n\
5439 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is\n\
5440 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.\n\
5442 Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{\"=m\"} / @code{\"=&m\"}) are\n\
5443 currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue\n\
5444 to use @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.\n\
5446 @code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are\n\
5447 copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate\n\
5448 (a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.\n\
5449 Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum\n\
5450 of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special\n\
5451 forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.",
5452 reg_class_t,
5453 (bool in_p, rtx x, reg_class_t reload_class, machine_mode reload_mode,
5454 secondary_reload_info *sri),
5455 default_secondary_reload)
5457 DEFHOOK
5458 (secondary_memory_needed,
5459 "Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied\n\
5460 to some other registers without using memory. Define this hook on\n\
5461 those machines to return true if objects of mode @var{m} in registers\n\
5462 of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of class @var{class2} by\n\
5463 storing a register of @var{class1} into memory and loading that memory\n\
5464 location into a register of @var{class2}. The default definition returns\n\
5465 false for all inputs.",
5466 bool, (machine_mode mode, reg_class_t class1, reg_class_t class2),
5467 hook_bool_mode_reg_class_t_reg_class_t_false)
5469 DEFHOOK
5470 (secondary_memory_needed_mode,
5471 "If @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} tells the compiler to use memory\n\
5472 when moving between two particular registers of mode @var{mode},\n\
5473 this hook specifies the mode that the memory should have.\n\
5475 The default depends on @code{TARGET_LRA_P}. Without LRA, the default\n\
5476 is to use a word-sized mode for integral modes that are smaller than a\n\
5477 a word. This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures\n\
5478 that all bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the\n\
5479 registers in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for\n\
5480 floating-point registers.\n\
5482 However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as\n\
5483 the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers\n\
5484 differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default\n\
5485 widening will not work correctly and you must define this hook to\n\
5486 suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.c} for\n\
5487 details.\n\
5489 With LRA, the default is to use @var{mode} unmodified.",
5490 machine_mode, (machine_mode mode),
5491 default_secondary_memory_needed_mode)
5493 /* Given an rtx X being reloaded into a reg required to be in class CLASS,
5494 return the class of reg to actually use. */
5495 DEFHOOK
5496 (preferred_reload_class,
5497 "A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class\n\
5498 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class\n\
5499 @var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps\n\
5500 another, smaller class.\n\
5502 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.\n\
5504 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For\n\
5505 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range\n\
5506 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always\n\
5507 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.\n\
5508 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.\n\
5510 One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return\n\
5511 @var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be\n\
5512 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can\n\
5513 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load\n\
5514 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an\n\
5515 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point\n\
5516 register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when\n\
5517 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded\n\
5518 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if\n\
5519 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead\n\
5520 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.\n\
5522 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go\n\
5523 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}\n\
5524 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes\n\
5525 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses\n\
5526 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in\n\
5527 the SSE registers (and vice versa).",
5528 reg_class_t,
5529 (rtx x, reg_class_t rclass),
5530 default_preferred_reload_class)
5532 /* Like TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS, but for output reloads instead of
5533 input reloads. */
5534 DEFHOOK
5535 (preferred_output_reload_class,
5536 "Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of\n\
5537 input reloads.\n\
5539 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}\n\
5540 argument.\n\
5542 You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage\n\
5543 reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.",
5544 reg_class_t,
5545 (rtx x, reg_class_t rclass),
5546 default_preferred_output_reload_class)
5548 DEFHOOK
5549 (class_likely_spilled_p,
5550 "A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned\n\
5551 to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because\n\
5552 registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.\n\
5554 The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}\n\
5555 has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this\n\
5556 default should be used. For generally register-starved machines, such as\n\
5557 i386, or machines with right register constraints, such as SH, this hook\n\
5558 can be used to avoid excessive spilling.\n\
5560 This hook is also used by some of the global intra-procedural code\n\
5561 transformations to throtle code motion, to avoid increasing register\n\
5562 pressure.",
5563 bool, (reg_class_t rclass),
5564 default_class_likely_spilled_p)
5566 /* Return the maximum number of consecutive registers
5567 needed to represent mode MODE in a register of class RCLASS. */
5568 DEFHOOK
5569 (class_max_nregs,
5570 "A target hook returns the maximum number of consecutive registers\n\
5571 of class @var{rclass} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.\n\
5573 This is closely related to the macro @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_NREGS}.\n\
5574 In fact, the value returned by @code{TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{rclass},\n\
5575 @var{mode})} target hook should be the maximum value of\n\
5576 @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})} for all @var{regno}\n\
5577 values in the class @var{rclass}.\n\
5579 This target hook helps control the handling of multiple-word values\n\
5580 in the reload pass.\n\
5582 The default version of this target hook returns the size of @var{mode}\n\
5583 in words.",
5584 unsigned char, (reg_class_t rclass, machine_mode mode),
5585 default_class_max_nregs)
5587 DEFHOOK
5588 (preferred_rename_class,
5589 "A target hook that places additional preference on the register\
5590 class to use when it is necessary to rename a register in class\
5591 @var{rclass} to another class, or perhaps @var{NO_REGS}, if no\
5592 preferred register class is found or hook @code{preferred_rename_class}\
5593 is not implemented.\
5594 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For\
5595 example, on ARM, thumb-2 instructions using @code{LO_REGS} may be\
5596 smaller than instructions using @code{GENERIC_REGS}. By returning\
5597 @code{LO_REGS} from @code{preferred_rename_class}, code size can\
5598 be reduced.",
5599 reg_class_t, (reg_class_t rclass),
5600 default_preferred_rename_class)
5602 /* This target hook allows the backend to avoid unsafe substitution
5603 during register allocation. */
5604 DEFHOOK
5605 (cannot_substitute_mem_equiv_p,
5606 "A target hook which returns @code{true} if @var{subst} can't\n\
5607 substitute safely pseudos with equivalent memory values during\n\
5608 register allocation.\n\
5609 The default version of this target hook returns @code{false}.\n\
5610 On most machines, this default should be used. For generally\n\
5611 machines with non orthogonal register usage for addressing, such\n\
5612 as SH, this hook can be used to avoid excessive spilling.",
5613 bool, (rtx subst),
5614 hook_bool_rtx_false)
5616 /* This target hook allows the backend to legitimize base plus
5617 displacement addressing. */
5618 DEFHOOK
5619 (legitimize_address_displacement,
5620 "A target hook which returns @code{true} if *@var{disp} is\n\
5621 legitimezed to valid address displacement with subtracting *@var{offset}\n\
5622 at memory mode @var{mode}.\n\
5623 The default version of this target hook returns @code{false}.\n\
5624 This hook will benefit machines with limited base plus displacement\n\
5625 addressing.",
5626 bool, (rtx *disp, rtx *offset, machine_mode mode),
5627 default_legitimize_address_displacement)
5629 /* This target hook allows the backend to perform additional
5630 processing while initializing for variable expansion. */
5631 DEFHOOK
5632 (expand_to_rtl_hook,
5633 "This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target\n\
5634 to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.\n\
5635 For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot\n\
5636 for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point\n\
5637 registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode\n\
5638 usage.",
5639 void, (void),
5640 hook_void_void)
5642 /* This target hook allows the backend to perform additional
5643 instantiations on rtx that are not actually in insns yet,
5644 but will be later. */
5645 DEFHOOK
5646 (instantiate_decls,
5647 "This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl\n\
5648 that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.",
5649 void, (void),
5650 hook_void_void)
5652 DEFHOOK
5653 (hard_regno_nregs,
5654 "This hook returns the number of consecutive hard registers, starting\n\
5655 at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode\n\
5656 @var{mode}. This hook must never return zero, even if a register\n\
5657 cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with\n\
5658 @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} and/or\n\
5659 @code{TARGET_CAN_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} instead.\n\
5661 The default definition returns the number of words in @var{mode}.",
5662 unsigned int, (unsigned int regno, machine_mode mode),
5663 default_hard_regno_nregs)
5665 DEFHOOK
5666 (hard_regno_mode_ok,
5667 "This hook returns true if it is permissible to store a value\n\
5668 of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several\n\
5669 registers starting with that one). The default definition returns true\n\
5670 unconditionally.\n\
5672 You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,\n\
5673 because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.\n\
5675 @cindex register pairs\n\
5676 On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd\n\
5677 register pairs. You can implement that by defining this hook to reject\n\
5678 odd register numbers for such modes.\n\
5680 The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the\n\
5681 @samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the\n\
5682 register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a\n\
5683 value into the register and back out not alter it.\n\
5685 Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for\n\
5686 all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for\n\
5687 this hook to distinguish between these modes, provided you define\n\
5688 patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This is\n\
5689 useful because of the interaction between @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}\n\
5690 and @code{TARGET_MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer\n\
5691 modes to be tieable.\n\
5693 Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.\n\
5694 Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only\n\
5695 in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that\n\
5696 can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine\n\
5697 mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those\n\
5698 registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.\n\
5700 On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine\n\
5701 modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating\n\
5702 registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a\n\
5703 non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,\n\
5704 @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in\n\
5705 floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically\n\
5706 normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it\n\
5707 unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating\n\
5708 register, so you can define this hook to say so.\n\
5710 The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that\n\
5711 they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic\n\
5712 instructions. However, this is of no concern to\n\
5713 @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper\n\
5714 constraints for those instructions.\n\
5716 On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,\n\
5717 so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a\n\
5718 register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the\n\
5719 floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not\n\
5720 be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.",
5721 bool, (unsigned int regno, machine_mode mode),
5722 hook_bool_uint_mode_true)
5724 DEFHOOK
5725 (modes_tieable_p,
5726 "This hook returns true if a value of mode @var{mode1} is accessible\n\
5727 in mode @var{mode2} without copying.\n\
5729 If @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and\n\
5730 @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always\n\
5731 the same for any @var{r}, then\n\
5732 @code{TARGET_MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}\n\
5733 should be true. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define\n\
5734 this hook to return false unless some other mechanism ensures the\n\
5735 accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.\n\
5737 You should define this hook to return true in as many cases as\n\
5738 possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register\n\
5739 allocation. The default definition returns true unconditionally.",
5740 bool, (machine_mode mode1, machine_mode mode2),
5741 hook_bool_mode_mode_true)
5743 /* Return true if is OK to use a hard register REGNO as scratch register
5744 in peephole2. */
5745 DEFHOOK
5746 (hard_regno_scratch_ok,
5747 "This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register\n\
5748 @var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.\n\
5750 One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that\n\
5751 is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.\n\
5753 The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.",
5754 bool, (unsigned int regno),
5755 default_hard_regno_scratch_ok)
5757 DEFHOOK
5758 (hard_regno_call_part_clobbered,
5759 "This hook should return true if @var{regno} is partly call-saved and\n\
5760 partly call-clobbered, and if a value of mode @var{mode} would be partly\n\
5761 clobbered by a call. For example, if the low 32 bits of @var{regno} are\n\
5762 preserved across a call but higher bits are clobbered, this hook should\n\
5763 return true for a 64-bit mode but false for a 32-bit mode.\n\
5765 The default implementation returns false, which is correct\n\
5766 for targets that don't have partly call-clobbered registers.",
5767 bool, (unsigned int regno, machine_mode mode),
5768 hook_bool_uint_mode_false)
5770 /* Return the smallest number of different values for which it is best to
5771 use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches. */
5772 DEFHOOK
5773 (case_values_threshold,
5774 "This function return the smallest number of different values for which it\n\
5775 is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.\n\
5776 The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and\n\
5777 five otherwise. This is best for most machines.",
5778 unsigned int, (void),
5779 default_case_values_threshold)
5781 DEFHOOK
5782 (starting_frame_offset,
5783 "This hook returns the offset from the frame pointer to the first local\n\
5784 variable slot to be allocated. If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, it is the\n\
5785 offset to @emph{end} of the first slot allocated, otherwise it is the\n\
5786 offset to @emph{beginning} of the first slot allocated. The default\n\
5787 implementation returns 0.",
5788 HOST_WIDE_INT, (void),
5789 hook_hwi_void_0)
5791 /* Optional callback to advise the target to compute the frame layout. */
5792 DEFHOOK
5793 (compute_frame_layout,
5794 "This target hook is called once each time the frame layout needs to be\n\
5795 recalculated. The calculations can be cached by the target and can then\n\
5796 be used by @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET} instead of re-computing the\n\
5797 layout on every invocation of that hook. This is particularly useful\n\
5798 for targets that have an expensive frame layout function. Implementing\n\
5799 this callback is optional.",
5800 void, (void),
5801 hook_void_void)
5803 /* Return true if a function must have and use a frame pointer. */
5804 DEFHOOK
5805 (frame_pointer_required,
5806 "This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use\n\
5807 a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return\n\
5808 value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.\n\
5810 This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide\n\
5811 according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the\n\
5812 constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code\n\
5813 to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.\n\
5814 Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame\n\
5815 pointer.\n\
5817 In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code\n\
5818 without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and\n\
5819 automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what\n\
5820 @code{targetm.frame_pointer_required} returns. You don't need to worry about\n\
5821 them.\n\
5823 In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer\n\
5824 register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a\n\
5825 fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.\n\
5827 Default return value is @code{false}.",
5828 bool, (void),
5829 hook_bool_void_false)
5831 /* Returns true if the compiler is allowed to try to replace register number
5832 from-reg with register number to-reg. */
5833 DEFHOOK
5834 (can_eliminate,
5835 "This target hook should return @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to\n\
5836 try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number\n\
5837 @var{to_reg}. This target hook will usually be @code{true}, since most of the\n\
5838 cases preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already\n\
5839 knows about.\n\
5841 Default return value is @code{true}.",
5842 bool, (const int from_reg, const int to_reg),
5843 hook_bool_const_int_const_int_true)
5845 /* Modify any or all of fixed_regs, call_used_regs, global_regs,
5846 reg_names, and reg_class_contents to account of the vagaries of the
5847 target. */
5848 DEFHOOK
5849 (conditional_register_usage,
5850 "This hook may conditionally modify five variables\n\
5851 @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},\n\
5852 @code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account\n\
5853 any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three\n\
5854 of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as boolean vectors).\n\
5855 @code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and\n\
5856 @code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is\n\
5857 called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},\n\
5858 @code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized\n\
5859 from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},\n\
5860 @code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.\n\
5861 @code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},\n\
5862 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}\n\
5863 command options have been applied.\n\
5865 @cindex disabling certain registers\n\
5866 @cindex controlling register usage\n\
5867 If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target\n\
5868 flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify\n\
5869 @code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the\n\
5870 registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also make\n\
5871 @code{define_register_constraint}s return @code{NO_REGS} for constraints\n\
5872 that shouldn't be used.\n\
5874 (However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all\n\
5875 of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are\n\
5876 controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using\n\
5877 these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)",
5878 void, (void),
5879 hook_void_void)
5881 DEFHOOK
5882 (stack_clash_protection_final_dynamic_probe,
5883 "Some targets make optimistic assumptions about the state of stack probing when they emit their prologues. On such targets a probe into the end of any dynamically allocated space is likely required for safety against stack clash style attacks. Define this variable to return nonzero if such a probe is required or zero otherwise. You need not define this macro if it would always have the value zero.",
5884 bool, (rtx residual),
5885 default_stack_clash_protection_final_dynamic_probe)
5888 /* Functions specific to the C family of frontends. */
5889 #undef HOOK_PREFIX
5890 #define HOOK_PREFIX "TARGET_C_"
5891 HOOK_VECTOR (TARGET_C, c)
5893 /* ??? Documenting this hook requires a GFDL license grant. */
5894 DEFHOOK_UNDOC
5895 (mode_for_suffix,
5896 "Return machine mode for non-standard constant literal suffix @var{c},\
5897 or VOIDmode if non-standard suffixes are unsupported.",
5898 machine_mode, (char c),
5899 default_mode_for_suffix)
5901 DEFHOOK
5902 (excess_precision,
5903 "Return a value, with the same meaning as the C99 macro\
5904 @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} that describes which excess precision should be\
5905 applied. @var{type} is either @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_IMPLICIT},\
5906 @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_FAST}, or\
5907 @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_STANDARD}. For\
5908 @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_IMPLICIT}, the target should return which\
5909 precision and range operations will be implictly evaluated in regardless\
5910 of the excess precision explicitly added. For\
5911 @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_STANDARD} and\
5912 @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_FAST}, the target should return the\
5913 explicit excess precision that should be added depending on the\
5914 value set for @option{-fexcess-precision=@r{[}standard@r{|}fast@r{]}}.\
5915 Note that unpredictable explicit excess precision does not make sense,\
5916 so a target should never return @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD_UNPREDICTABLE}\
5917 when @var{type} is @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_STANDARD} or\
5918 @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_FAST}.",
5919 enum flt_eval_method, (enum excess_precision_type type),
5920 default_excess_precision)
5922 HOOK_VECTOR_END (c)
5924 /* Functions specific to the C++ frontend. */
5925 #undef HOOK_PREFIX
5926 #define HOOK_PREFIX "TARGET_CXX_"
5927 HOOK_VECTOR (TARGET_CXX, cxx)
5929 /* Return the integer type used for guard variables. */
5930 DEFHOOK
5931 (guard_type,
5932 "Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.\n\
5933 These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The\n\
5934 default is long_long_integer_type_node.",
5935 tree, (void),
5936 default_cxx_guard_type)
5938 /* Return true if only the low bit of the guard should be tested. */
5939 DEFHOOK
5940 (guard_mask_bit,
5941 "This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return\n\
5942 @code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of\n\
5943 @code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.",
5944 bool, (void),
5945 hook_bool_void_false)
5947 /* Returns the size of the array cookie for an array of type. */
5948 DEFHOOK
5949 (get_cookie_size,
5950 "This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array\n\
5951 whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already\n\
5952 known that a cookie is needed. The default is\n\
5953 @code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the\n\
5954 IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.",
5955 tree, (tree type),
5956 default_cxx_get_cookie_size)
5958 /* Returns true if the element size should be stored in the array cookie. */
5959 DEFHOOK
5960 (cookie_has_size,
5961 "This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in\n\
5962 array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.",
5963 bool, (void),
5964 hook_bool_void_false)
5966 /* Allows backends to perform additional processing when
5967 deciding if a class should be exported or imported. */
5968 DEFHOOK
5969 (import_export_class,
5970 "If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export\n\
5971 class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}\n\
5972 will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going\n\
5973 to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the\n\
5974 modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the\n\
5975 backend's targeted operating system.",
5976 int, (tree type, int import_export), NULL)
5978 /* Returns true if constructors and destructors return "this". */
5979 DEFHOOK
5980 (cdtor_returns_this,
5981 "This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return\n\
5982 the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return\n\
5983 @code{false}.",
5984 bool, (void),
5985 hook_bool_void_false)
5987 /* Returns true if the key method for a class can be an inline
5988 function, so long as it is not declared inline in the class
5989 itself. Returning true is the behavior required by the Itanium C++ ABI. */
5990 DEFHOOK
5991 (key_method_may_be_inline,
5992 "This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method\n\
5993 which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual\n\
5994 table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard\n\
5995 Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as\n\
5996 the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under\n\
5997 some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key\n\
5998 method. The default is to return @code{true}.",
5999 bool, (void),
6000 hook_bool_void_true)
6002 DEFHOOK
6003 (determine_class_data_visibility,
6004 "@var{decl} is a virtual table, virtual table table, typeinfo object,\
6005 or other similar implicit class data object that will be emitted with\
6006 external linkage in this translation unit. No ELF visibility has been\
6007 explicitly specified. If the target needs to specify a visibility\
6008 other than that of the containing class, use this hook to set\
6009 @code{DECL_VISIBILITY} and @code{DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED}.",
6010 void, (tree decl),
6011 hook_void_tree)
6013 /* Returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
6014 similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they
6015 have external linkage. If this hook returns false, then
6016 class data for classes whose virtual table will be emitted in
6017 only one translation unit will not be COMDAT. */
6018 DEFHOOK
6019 (class_data_always_comdat,
6020 "This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other\n\
6021 similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have\n\
6022 external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for\n\
6023 classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation\n\
6024 unit will not be COMDAT.",
6025 bool, (void),
6026 hook_bool_void_true)
6028 /* Returns true (the default) if the RTTI for the basic types,
6029 which is always defined in the C++ runtime, should be COMDAT;
6030 false if it should not be COMDAT. */
6031 DEFHOOK
6032 (library_rtti_comdat,
6033 "This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for\n\
6034 the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always\n\
6035 be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.",
6036 bool, (void),
6037 hook_bool_void_true)
6039 /* Returns true if __aeabi_atexit should be used to register static
6040 destructors. */
6041 DEFHOOK
6042 (use_aeabi_atexit,
6043 "This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)\n\
6044 should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}\n\
6045 is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.",
6046 bool, (void),
6047 hook_bool_void_false)
6049 /* Returns true if target may use atexit in the same manner as
6050 __cxa_atexit to register static destructors. */
6051 DEFHOOK
6052 (use_atexit_for_cxa_atexit,
6053 "This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used\n\
6054 in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static\n\
6055 destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in\n\
6056 shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are\n\
6057 unloaded. The default is to return false.",
6058 bool, (void),
6059 hook_bool_void_false)
6061 DEFHOOK
6062 (adjust_class_at_definition,
6063 "@var{type} is a C++ class (i.e., RECORD_TYPE or UNION_TYPE) that has just\
6064 been defined. Use this hook to make adjustments to the class (eg, tweak\
6065 visibility or perform any other required target modifications).",
6066 void, (tree type),
6067 hook_void_tree)
6069 DEFHOOK
6070 (decl_mangling_context,
6071 "Return target-specific mangling context of @var{decl} or @code{NULL_TREE}.",
6072 tree, (const_tree decl),
6073 hook_tree_const_tree_null)
6075 HOOK_VECTOR_END (cxx)
6077 /* Functions and data for emulated TLS support. */
6078 #undef HOOK_PREFIX
6079 #define HOOK_PREFIX "TARGET_EMUTLS_"
6080 HOOK_VECTOR (TARGET_EMUTLS, emutls)
6082 /* Name of the address and common functions. */
6083 DEFHOOKPOD
6084 (get_address,
6085 "Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control\n\
6086 object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's\n\
6087 emulated TLS helper function to be used.",
6088 const char *, "__builtin___emutls_get_address")
6090 DEFHOOKPOD
6091 (register_common,
6092 "Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at\n\
6093 program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly\n\
6094 initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will\n\
6095 have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS\n\
6096 registration function to be used.",
6097 const char *, "__builtin___emutls_register_common")
6099 /* Prefixes for proxy variable and template. */
6100 DEFHOOKPOD
6101 (var_section,
6102 "Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should\n\
6103 be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in\n\
6104 any section.",
6105 const char *, NULL)
6107 DEFHOOKPOD
6108 (tmpl_section,
6109 "Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be\n\
6110 placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any\n\
6111 section.",
6112 const char *, NULL)
6114 /* Prefixes for proxy variable and template. */
6115 DEFHOOKPOD
6116 (var_prefix,
6117 "Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.\n\
6118 The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.",
6119 const char *, NULL)
6121 DEFHOOKPOD
6122 (tmpl_prefix,
6123 "Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The\n\
6124 default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.",
6125 const char *, NULL)
6127 /* Function to generate field definitions of the proxy variable. */
6128 DEFHOOK
6129 (var_fields,
6130 "Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control\n\
6131 object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and\n\
6132 @var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of\n\
6133 @code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable\n\
6134 for libgcc's emulated TLS function.",
6135 tree, (tree type, tree *name),
6136 default_emutls_var_fields)
6138 /* Function to initialize a proxy variable. */
6139 DEFHOOK
6140 (var_init,
6141 "Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a\n\
6142 TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}\n\
6143 is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the\n\
6144 initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.",
6145 tree, (tree var, tree decl, tree tmpl_addr),
6146 default_emutls_var_init)
6148 /* Whether we are allowed to alter the usual alignment of the
6149 proxy variable. */
6150 DEFHOOKPOD
6151 (var_align_fixed,
6152 "Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is\n\
6153 fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize\n\
6154 single objects. The default is false.",
6155 bool, false)
6157 /* Whether we can emit debug information for TLS vars. */
6158 DEFHOOKPOD
6159 (debug_form_tls_address,
6160 "Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor\n\
6161 may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.",
6162 bool, false)
6164 HOOK_VECTOR_END (emutls)
6166 #undef HOOK_PREFIX
6167 #define HOOK_PREFIX "TARGET_OPTION_"
6168 HOOK_VECTOR (TARGET_OPTION_HOOKS, target_option_hooks)
6170 /* Function to validate the attribute((target(...))) strings. If
6171 the option is validated, the hook should also fill in
6172 DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET in the function decl node. */
6173 DEFHOOK
6174 (valid_attribute_p,
6175 "This hook is called to parse @code{attribute(target(\"...\"))}, which\n\
6176 allows setting target-specific options on individual functions.\n\
6177 These function-specific options may differ\n\
6178 from the options specified on the command line. The hook should return\n\
6179 @code{true} if the options are valid.\n\
6181 The hook should set the @code{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in\n\
6182 the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target-specific\n\
6183 @code{struct cl_target_option} structure.",
6184 bool, (tree fndecl, tree name, tree args, int flags),
6185 default_target_option_valid_attribute_p)
6187 /* Function to save any extra target state in the target options structure. */
6188 DEFHOOK
6189 (save,
6190 "This hook is called to save any additional target-specific information\n\
6191 in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for function-specific\n\
6192 options from the @code{struct gcc_options} structure.\n\
6193 @xref{Option file format}.",
6194 void, (struct cl_target_option *ptr, struct gcc_options *opts), NULL)
6196 /* Function to restore any extra target state from the target options
6197 structure. */
6198 DEFHOOK
6199 (restore,
6200 "This hook is called to restore any additional target-specific\n\
6201 information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for\n\
6202 function-specific options to the @code{struct gcc_options} structure.",
6203 void, (struct gcc_options *opts, struct cl_target_option *ptr), NULL)
6205 /* Function to update target-specific option information after being
6206 streamed in. */
6207 DEFHOOK
6208 (post_stream_in,
6209 "This hook is called to update target-specific information in the\n\
6210 @code{struct cl_target_option} structure after it is streamed in from\n\
6211 LTO bytecode.",
6212 void, (struct cl_target_option *ptr), NULL)
6214 /* Function to print any extra target state from the target options
6215 structure. */
6216 DEFHOOK
6217 (print,
6218 "This hook is called to print any additional target-specific\n\
6219 information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for\n\
6220 function-specific options.",
6221 void, (FILE *file, int indent, struct cl_target_option *ptr), NULL)
6223 /* Function to parse arguments to be validated for #pragma target, and to
6224 change the state if the options are valid. If the first argument is
6225 NULL, the second argument specifies the default options to use. Return
6226 true if the options are valid, and set the current state. */
6227 DEFHOOK
6228 (pragma_parse,
6229 "This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC target}, which\n\
6230 sets the target-specific options for functions that occur later in the\n\
6231 input stream. The options accepted should be the same as those handled by the\n\
6232 @code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.",
6233 bool, (tree args, tree pop_target),
6234 default_target_option_pragma_parse)
6236 /* Do option overrides for the target. */
6237 DEFHOOK
6238 (override,
6239 "Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on\n\
6240 a particular target machine. You can override the hook\n\
6241 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called\n\
6242 once just after all the command options have been parsed.\n\
6244 Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for\n\
6245 @option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.\n\
6247 If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is\n\
6248 changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see\n\
6249 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}",
6250 void, (void),
6251 hook_void_void)
6253 /* This function returns true if DECL1 and DECL2 are versions of the same
6254 function. DECL1 and DECL2 are function versions if and only if they
6255 have the same function signature and different target specific attributes,
6256 that is, they are compiled for different target machines. */
6257 DEFHOOK
6258 (function_versions,
6259 "This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are\n\
6260 versions of the same function. @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are function\n\
6261 versions if and only if they have the same function signature and\n\
6262 different target specific attributes, that is, they are compiled for\n\
6263 different target machines.",
6264 bool, (tree decl1, tree decl2),
6265 hook_bool_tree_tree_false)
6267 /* Function to determine if one function can inline another function. */
6268 #undef HOOK_PREFIX
6269 #define HOOK_PREFIX "TARGET_"
6270 DEFHOOK
6271 (can_inline_p,
6272 "This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function\n\
6273 cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By\n\
6274 default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function\n\
6275 specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.",
6276 bool, (tree caller, tree callee),
6277 default_target_can_inline_p)
6279 DEFHOOK
6280 (relayout_function,
6281 "This target hook fixes function @var{fndecl} after attributes are processed. Default does nothing. On ARM, the default function's alignment is updated with the attribute target.",
6282 void, (tree fndecl),
6283 hook_void_tree)
6285 HOOK_VECTOR_END (target_option)
6287 /* For targets that need to mark extra registers as live on entry to
6288 the function, they should define this target hook and set their
6289 bits in the bitmap passed in. */
6290 DEFHOOK
6291 (extra_live_on_entry,
6292 "Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the\n\
6293 function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that\n\
6294 cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved\n\
6295 registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,\n\
6296 TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,\n\
6297 FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.",
6298 void, (bitmap regs),
6299 hook_void_bitmap)
6301 /* Targets should define this target hook to mark that non-callee clobbers are
6302 present in CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE for all the calls that bind to a local
6303 definition. */
6304 DEFHOOKPOD
6305 (call_fusage_contains_non_callee_clobbers,
6306 "Set to true if each call that binds to a local definition explicitly\n\
6307 clobbers or sets all non-fixed registers modified by performing the call.\n\
6308 That is, by the call pattern itself, or by code that might be inserted by the\n\
6309 linker (e.g. stubs, veneers, branch islands), but not including those\n\
6310 modifiable by the callee. The affected registers may be mentioned explicitly\n\
6311 in the call pattern, or included as clobbers in CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE.\n\
6312 The default version of this hook is set to false. The purpose of this hook\n\
6313 is to enable the fipa-ra optimization.",
6314 bool,
6315 false)
6317 /* Fill in additional registers set up by prologue into a regset. */
6318 DEFHOOK
6319 (set_up_by_prologue,
6320 "This hook should add additional registers that are computed by the prologue\
6321 to the hard regset for shrink-wrapping optimization purposes.",
6322 void, (struct hard_reg_set_container *),
6323 NULL)
6325 /* For targets that have attributes that can affect whether a
6326 function's return statements need checking. For instance a 'naked'
6327 function attribute. */
6328 DEFHOOK
6329 (warn_func_return,
6330 "True if a function's return statements should be checked for matching the function's return type. This includes checking for falling off the end of a non-void function. Return false if no such check should be made.",
6331 bool, (tree),
6332 hook_bool_tree_true)
6334 #undef HOOK_PREFIX
6335 #define HOOK_PREFIX "TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_"
6336 HOOK_VECTOR (TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_HOOKS, shrink_wrap)
6338 DEFHOOK
6339 (get_separate_components,
6340 "This hook should return an @code{sbitmap} with the bits set for those\n\
6341 components that can be separately shrink-wrapped in the current function.\n\
6342 Return @code{NULL} if the current function should not get any separate\n\
6343 shrink-wrapping.\n\
6344 Don't define this hook if it would always return @code{NULL}.\n\
6345 If it is defined, the other hooks in this group have to be defined as well.",
6346 sbitmap, (void),
6347 NULL)
6349 DEFHOOK
6350 (components_for_bb,
6351 "This hook should return an @code{sbitmap} with the bits set for those\n\
6352 components where either the prologue component has to be executed before\n\
6353 the @code{basic_block}, or the epilogue component after it, or both.",
6354 sbitmap, (basic_block),
6355 NULL)
6357 DEFHOOK
6358 (disqualify_components,
6359 "This hook should clear the bits in the @var{components} bitmap for those\n\
6360 components in @var{edge_components} that the target cannot handle on edge\n\
6361 @var{e}, where @var{is_prologue} says if this is for a prologue or an\n\
6362 epilogue instead.",
6363 void, (sbitmap components, edge e, sbitmap edge_components, bool is_prologue),
6364 NULL)
6366 DEFHOOK
6367 (emit_prologue_components,
6368 "Emit prologue insns for the components indicated by the parameter.",
6369 void, (sbitmap),
6370 NULL)
6372 DEFHOOK
6373 (emit_epilogue_components,
6374 "Emit epilogue insns for the components indicated by the parameter.",
6375 void, (sbitmap),
6376 NULL)
6378 DEFHOOK
6379 (set_handled_components,
6380 "Mark the components in the parameter as handled, so that the\n\
6381 @code{prologue} and @code{epilogue} named patterns know to ignore those\n\
6382 components. The target code should not hang on to the @code{sbitmap}, it\n\
6383 will be deleted after this call.",
6384 void, (sbitmap),
6385 NULL)
6387 HOOK_VECTOR_END (shrink_wrap)
6388 #undef HOOK_PREFIX
6389 #define HOOK_PREFIX "TARGET_"
6391 /* Determine the type of unwind info to emit for debugging. */
6392 DEFHOOK
6393 (debug_unwind_info,
6394 "This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame\n\
6395 unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return\n\
6396 @code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and\n\
6397 return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.\n\
6399 A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information\n\
6400 is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.\n\
6402 A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.\n\
6403 This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.",
6404 enum unwind_info_type, (void),
6405 default_debug_unwind_info)
6407 /* The code parameter should be of type enum rtx_code but this is not
6408 defined at this time. */
6409 DEFHOOK
6410 (canonicalize_comparison,
6411 "On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can\n\
6412 convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha\n\
6413 does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}\n\
6414 comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.\n\
6416 On such machines, implement this hook to do any required conversions.\n\
6417 @var{code} is the initial comparison code and @var{op0} and @var{op1}\n\
6418 are the left and right operands of the comparison, respectively. If\n\
6419 @var{op0_preserve_value} is @code{true} the implementation is not\n\
6420 allowed to change the value of @var{op0} since the value might be used\n\
6421 in RTXs which aren't comparisons. E.g. the implementation is not\n\
6422 allowed to swap operands in that case.\n\
6424 GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is\n\
6425 valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the\n\
6426 @file{md} file.\n\
6428 You need not to implement this hook if it would never change the\n\
6429 comparison code or operands.",
6430 void, (int *code, rtx *op0, rtx *op1, bool op0_preserve_value),
6431 default_canonicalize_comparison)
6433 DEFHOOK
6434 (min_arithmetic_precision,
6435 "On some RISC architectures with 64-bit registers, the processor also\n\
6436 maintains 32-bit condition codes that make it possible to do real 32-bit\n\
6437 arithmetic, although the operations are performed on the full registers.\n\
6439 On such architectures, defining this hook to 32 tells the compiler to try\n\
6440 using 32-bit arithmetical operations setting the condition codes instead\n\
6441 of doing full 64-bit arithmetic.\n\
6443 More generally, define this hook on RISC architectures if you want the\n\
6444 compiler to try using arithmetical operations setting the condition codes\n\
6445 with a precision lower than the word precision.\n\
6447 You need not define this hook if @code{WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS} is not\n\
6448 defined to 1.",
6449 unsigned int, (void), default_min_arithmetic_precision)
6451 DEFHOOKPOD
6452 (atomic_test_and_set_trueval,
6453 "This value should be set if the result written by\
6454 @code{atomic_test_and_set} is not exactly 1, i.e. the\
6455 @code{bool} @code{true}.",
6456 unsigned char, 1)
6458 /* Return an unsigned int representing the alignment (in bits) of the atomic
6459 type which maps to machine MODE. This allows alignment to be overridden
6460 as needed. */
6461 DEFHOOK
6462 (atomic_align_for_mode,
6463 "If defined, this function returns an appropriate alignment in bits for an\
6464 atomic object of machine_mode @var{mode}. If 0 is returned then the\
6465 default alignment for the specified mode is used. ",
6466 unsigned int, (machine_mode mode),
6467 hook_uint_mode_0)
6469 DEFHOOK
6470 (atomic_assign_expand_fenv,
6471 "ISO C11 requires atomic compound assignments that may raise floating-point\
6472 exceptions to raise exceptions corresponding to the arithmetic operation\
6473 whose result was successfully stored in a compare-and-exchange sequence. \
6474 This requires code equivalent to calls to @code{feholdexcept},\
6475 @code{feclearexcept} and @code{feupdateenv} to be generated at\
6476 appropriate points in the compare-and-exchange sequence. This hook should\
6477 set @code{*@var{hold}} to an expression equivalent to the call to\
6478 @code{feholdexcept}, @code{*@var{clear}} to an expression equivalent to\
6479 the call to @code{feclearexcept} and @code{*@var{update}} to an expression\
6480 equivalent to the call to @code{feupdateenv}. The three expressions are\
6481 @code{NULL_TREE} on entry to the hook and may be left as @code{NULL_TREE}\
6482 if no code is required in a particular place. The default implementation\
6483 leaves all three expressions as @code{NULL_TREE}. The\
6484 @code{__atomic_feraiseexcept} function from @code{libatomic} may be of use\
6485 as part of the code generated in @code{*@var{update}}.",
6486 void, (tree *hold, tree *clear, tree *update),
6487 default_atomic_assign_expand_fenv)
6489 /* Leave the boolean fields at the end. */
6491 /* True if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS section
6492 and then using ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP to allocate the space. */
6493 DEFHOOKPOD
6494 (have_switchable_bss_sections,
6495 "This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS\n\
6496 section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.\n\
6497 This is true on most ELF targets.",
6498 bool, false)
6500 /* True if "native" constructors and destructors are supported,
6501 false if we're using collect2 for the job. */
6502 DEFHOOKPOD
6503 (have_ctors_dtors,
6504 "This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of\n\
6505 collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.\n\
6506 It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.",
6507 bool, false)
6509 /* True if thread-local storage is supported. */
6510 DEFHOOKPOD
6511 (have_tls,
6512 "Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.\n\
6513 The default value is false.",
6514 bool, false)
6516 /* True if a small readonly data section is supported. */
6517 DEFHOOKPOD
6518 (have_srodata_section,
6519 "Contains the value true if the target places read-only\n\
6520 ``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.",
6521 bool, false)
6523 /* True if EH frame info sections should be zero-terminated. */
6524 DEFHOOKPOD
6525 (terminate_dw2_eh_frame_info,
6526 "Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the\n\
6527 end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.\n\
6528 Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and\n\
6529 true otherwise.",
6530 bool, true)
6532 /* True if #NO_APP should be emitted at the beginning of assembly output. */
6533 DEFHOOKPOD
6534 (asm_file_start_app_off,
6535 "If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be\n\
6536 printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless\n\
6537 @option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined\n\
6538 to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal\n\
6539 definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU\n\
6540 assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra\n\
6541 whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.\n\
6543 The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have\n\
6544 verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or\n\
6545 comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.",
6546 bool, false)
6548 /* True if output_file_directive should be called for main_input_filename
6549 at the beginning of assembly output. */
6550 DEFHOOKPOD
6551 (asm_file_start_file_directive,
6552 "If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called\n\
6553 for the primary source file, immediately after printing\n\
6554 @code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect\n\
6555 this to be done. The default is false.",
6556 bool, false)
6558 /* Returns true if we should generate exception tables for use with the
6559 ARM EABI. The effects the encoding of function exception specifications. */
6560 DEFHOOKPOD
6561 (arm_eabi_unwinder,
6562 "This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI\n\
6563 based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects\n\
6564 the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after\n\
6565 running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.",
6566 bool, false)
6568 DEFHOOKPOD
6569 (want_debug_pub_sections,
6570 "True if the @code{.debug_pubtypes} and @code{.debug_pubnames} sections\
6571 should be emitted. These sections are not used on most platforms, and\
6572 in particular GDB does not use them.",
6573 bool, false)
6575 DEFHOOKPOD
6576 (delay_sched2, "True if sched2 is not to be run at its normal place.\n\
6577 This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.",
6578 bool, false)
6580 DEFHOOKPOD
6581 (delay_vartrack, "True if vartrack is not to be run at its normal place.\n\
6582 This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.",
6583 bool, false)
6585 DEFHOOKPOD
6586 (no_register_allocation, "True if register allocation and the passes\n\
6587 following it should not be run. Usually true only for virtual assembler\n\
6588 targets.",
6589 bool, false)
6591 /* Leave the boolean fields at the end. */
6593 /* Functions related to mode switching. */
6594 #undef HOOK_PREFIX
6595 #define HOOK_PREFIX "TARGET_MODE_"
6596 HOOK_VECTOR (TARGET_TOGGLE_, mode_switching)
6598 DEFHOOK
6599 (emit,
6600 "Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}. @var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where the insn(s) are to be inserted. @var{prev_moxde} indicates the mode to switch from. Sets of a lower numbered entity will be emitted before sets of a higher numbered entity to a mode of the same or lower priority.",
6601 void, (int entity, int mode, int prev_mode, HARD_REG_SET regs_live), NULL)
6603 DEFHOOK
6604 (needed,
6605 "@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.",
6606 int, (int entity, rtx_insn *insn), NULL)
6608 DEFHOOK
6609 (after,
6610 "@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if different from the incoming mode).",
6611 int, (int entity, int mode, rtx_insn *insn), NULL)
6613 DEFHOOK
6614 (entry,
6615 "If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY} is defined then @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT} must be defined.",
6616 int, (int entity), NULL)
6618 DEFHOOK
6619 (exit,
6620 "If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT} is defined then @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.",
6621 int, (int entity), NULL)
6623 DEFHOOK
6624 (priority,
6625 "This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed. 0 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority} (@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{} @code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.",
6626 int, (int entity, int n), NULL)
6628 HOOK_VECTOR_END (mode_switching)
6630 #undef HOOK_PREFIX
6631 #define HOOK_PREFIX "TARGET_"
6633 #define DEF_TARGET_INSN(NAME, PROTO) \
6634 DEFHOOK_UNDOC (have_##NAME, "", bool, (void), false)
6635 #include "target-insns.def"
6636 #undef DEF_TARGET_INSN
6638 #define DEF_TARGET_INSN(NAME, PROTO) \
6639 DEFHOOK_UNDOC (gen_##NAME, "", rtx_insn *, PROTO, NULL)
6640 #include "target-insns.def"
6641 #undef DEF_TARGET_INSN
6643 #define DEF_TARGET_INSN(NAME, PROTO) \
6644 DEFHOOKPOD (code_for_##NAME, "*", enum insn_code, CODE_FOR_nothing)
6645 #include "target-insns.def"
6646 #undef DEF_TARGET_INSN
6648 DEFHOOK
6649 (run_target_selftests,
6650 "If selftests are enabled, run any selftests for this target.",
6651 void, (void),
6652 NULL)
6654 /* Close the 'struct gcc_target' definition. */
6655 HOOK_VECTOR_END (C90_EMPTY_HACK)